WO2015038655A1 - Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof - Google Patents

Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2015038655A1
WO2015038655A1 PCT/US2014/055012 US2014055012W WO2015038655A1 WO 2015038655 A1 WO2015038655 A1 WO 2015038655A1 US 2014055012 W US2014055012 W US 2014055012W WO 2015038655 A1 WO2015038655 A1 WO 2015038655A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
compound
optionally substituted
phenyl
alkyl
pharmaceutically acceptable
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US2014/055012
Other languages
French (fr)
Inventor
Leonid Beigelman
David Bernard Smith
Antitsa Dimitrova Stoycheva
Robert Than Hendricks
Original Assignee
Alios Biopharma, Inc.
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Priority to CA2923075A priority Critical patent/CA2923075C/en
Priority to BR112016005270-6A priority patent/BR112016005270B1/en
Priority to AU2014318832A priority patent/AU2014318832B2/en
Priority to ES14844961T priority patent/ES2821394T3/en
Priority to CN201480061771.XA priority patent/CN105764904B/en
Priority to KR1020217035836A priority patent/KR102468319B1/en
Priority to NZ717591A priority patent/NZ717591B2/en
Application filed by Alios Biopharma, Inc. filed Critical Alios Biopharma, Inc.
Priority to JP2016542073A priority patent/JP6448647B2/en
Priority to KR1020167009194A priority patent/KR102323515B1/en
Priority to UAA201602294A priority patent/UA121199C2/en
Priority to EA201690372A priority patent/EA037949B1/en
Priority to EP20184298.6A priority patent/EP3778603A1/en
Priority to EP14844961.4A priority patent/EP3030566B1/en
Priority to MX2016003199A priority patent/MX2016003199A/en
Publication of WO2015038655A1 publication Critical patent/WO2015038655A1/en
Priority to IL244432A priority patent/IL244432B/en
Priority to PH12016500486A priority patent/PH12016500486A1/en
Priority to AU2019201403A priority patent/AU2019201403B2/en
Priority to IL274355A priority patent/IL274355B/en

Links

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/50Pyridazines; Hydrogenated pyridazines
    • A61K31/5025Pyridazines; Hydrogenated pyridazines ortho- or peri-condensed with heterocyclic ring systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/13Amines
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/185Acids; Anhydrides, halides or salts thereof, e.g. sulfur acids, imidic, hydrazonic or hydroximic acids
    • A61K31/19Carboxylic acids, e.g. valproic acid
    • A61K31/195Carboxylic acids, e.g. valproic acid having an amino group
    • A61K31/196Carboxylic acids, e.g. valproic acid having an amino group the amino group being directly attached to a ring, e.g. anthranilic acid, mefenamic acid, diclofenac, chlorambucil
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/21Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates
    • A61K31/215Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates of carboxylic acids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/335Heterocyclic compounds having oxygen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. fungichromin
    • A61K31/35Heterocyclic compounds having oxygen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. fungichromin having six-membered rings with one oxygen as the only ring hetero atom
    • A61K31/351Heterocyclic compounds having oxygen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. fungichromin having six-membered rings with one oxygen as the only ring hetero atom not condensed with another ring
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/4965Non-condensed pyrazines
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/4985Pyrazines or piperazines ortho- or peri-condensed with heterocyclic ring systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/535Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with at least one nitrogen and one oxygen as the ring hetero atoms, e.g. 1,2-oxazines
    • A61K31/53751,4-Oxazines, e.g. morpholine
    • A61K31/53771,4-Oxazines, e.g. morpholine not condensed and containing further heterocyclic rings, e.g. timolol
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/70Carbohydrates; Sugars; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K31/7042Compounds having saccharide radicals and heterocyclic rings
    • A61K31/7052Compounds having saccharide radicals and heterocyclic rings having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. nucleosides, nucleotides
    • A61K31/7056Compounds having saccharide radicals and heterocyclic rings having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. nucleosides, nucleotides containing five-membered rings with nitrogen as a ring hetero atom
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K38/00Medicinal preparations containing peptides
    • A61K38/16Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K38/17Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans
    • A61K38/19Cytokines; Lymphokines; Interferons
    • A61K38/21Interferons [IFN]
    • A61K38/212IFN-alpha
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K45/00Medicinal preparations containing active ingredients not provided for in groups A61K31/00 - A61K41/00
    • A61K45/06Mixtures of active ingredients without chemical characterisation, e.g. antiphlogistics and cardiaca
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/14Antivirals for RNA viruses
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • A61P31/14Antivirals for RNA viruses
    • A61P31/16Antivirals for RNA viruses for influenza or rhinoviruses
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07BGENERAL METHODS OF ORGANIC CHEMISTRY; APPARATUS THEREFOR
    • C07B59/00Introduction of isotopes of elements into organic compounds ; Labelled organic compounds per se
    • C07B59/002Heterocyclic compounds
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D487/00Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D477/00
    • C07D487/02Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D477/00 in which the condensed system contains two hetero rings
    • C07D487/04Ortho-condensed systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K2300/00Mixtures or combinations of active ingredients, wherein at least one active ingredient is fully defined in groups A61K31/00 - A61K41/00
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07BGENERAL METHODS OF ORGANIC CHEMISTRY; APPARATUS THEREFOR
    • C07B2200/00Indexing scheme relating to specific properties of organic compounds
    • C07B2200/05Isotopically modified compounds, e.g. labelled

Definitions

  • the present application relates to the fields of chemistry, biochemistry and medicine. More particularly, disclosed herein are aza-pyridone compounds, pharmaceutical compositions that include one or more aza-pyridone compounds, and methods of synthesizing the same. Also disclosed herein are methods of ameliorating and/or treating an orthomyxovirus viral infection with one or more aza-pyridone compounds.
  • the viruses of the Orthomyxoviridae family are negative-sense, single- stranded RNA viruses.
  • the Orthomyxoviridae family contains several genera including Influenzavirus A, Influenzavirus B, Influenzavirus C. Isavirus and Thogotovirus.
  • Influenzaviruses can cause respiratory viral infections, including upper and lower respiratory tract viral infections. Respiratory viral infections are a leading cause of death of millions of people each year. Upper respiratory tract viral infections involve the nose, sinuses, pharynx and/or larynx. Lower respiratory tract viral infections involve the respiratory system below the vocal cords, including the trachea, primary 7 bronchi and lungs.
  • Some embodiments disclosed herein relate to a compound of Formula (T), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • Some embodiments disclosed herein relate to methods of ameliorating and/or treating an orthomyxovirus viral infection that can include administering to a subject suffering from the orthomyxovirus viral infection an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • Other embodiments described herein relate to using one or more compounds of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in the manufacture of a medicament for ameliorating and/or treating an orthomyxovirus viral infection.
  • Still other embodiments described herein relate to a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, that can be used for ameliorating and/or treating an orthomyxovirus viral infection.
  • orthomyxovirus viral infection can include contacting a cell infected with the orthomyxovirus with an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • Some embodiments disclosed herein relate to methods of preventing an orthomyxovirus infection that can include administering to a subject an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the orthomyxovirus viral infection can be an influenza viral infection (such as influenza A. B and/or C).
  • Some embodiments disclosed herein relate to methods of inhibiting the replication of an orthomyxovirus that can include contacting a cell infected with the orthomyxovirus with an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the orthomyxovirus viral infection can be an influenza viral infection (such as influenza A, B and/or C).
  • influenza viral infection such as influenza A, B and/or C.
  • Other embodiments disclosed herein relate to a method for inhibiting endonuclease activity of an influenza endonuclease that can include contacting the active site of the endonuclease with an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • Figure 1 shows example anti-influenza agents.
  • Influenza is a negative sense, single stranded RNA virus and a member of the Orthomyxoviridae family. There are currently three species of influenza; influenza A, influenza B and influenza C. Influenza A has a lipid membrane derived from the host cell, which contains the hemagglutinin, neuramididase and M2 proteins that project from the surface of the virus. Influenza A has been further classified based the hemagglutinin (I I or HA) and the neuramididase (N). There are approximately 16 H antigens (HI to HI 6) and 9 N antigens (Nl to N9). Influenza A includes several subtypes, including H1N1. H1N2. H2N2. H3N1.
  • influenza virus polymerase is a heterotrimer composed of three subunits. polymerase acid (PA), polymerase basic 1 (PB 1 ) and polymerase basic 2 (PB2). This polymerase is responsible for replication and transcription of the viral RNA in the nuclei of infected cells.
  • PA polymerase acid
  • PB 1 polymerase basic 1
  • PB2 polymerase basic 2
  • This polymerase is responsible for replication and transcription of the viral RNA in the nuclei of infected cells.
  • the PA subunit contains the endonuclease active site. The endonuclease activity of the PA cleaves the cellular mRNA. which is then used by the PB 1 subunit as a primer for the viral mRNA synthesis.
  • Influenza viruses can be transmitted from person to person via direct contact with infected secretions and/or contaminated surfaces or objections.
  • Complications from an influenza viral infection include pneumonia, bronchitis, dehydration, and sinus and ear infections.
  • Medications currently approved by the FDA against an influenza infection include a limited number of neuraminidase inhibitors and M2 protein inhibitors. Examples of approved neuraminidase inhibitors and 2 protein inhibitors include amantadine, rimantadine, Relenza® (zanamivir. GlaxoSmithKline) and Tamiflu® (oseltamivir. Genentech).
  • any "R” group(s) such as, without limitation, R 1 , R 2 , R "ia , R b , R 4 , R ⁇ and R b represent substituents that can be attached to the indicated atom.
  • An R group may be substituted or unsubstituted. If two "R” groups are described as being “taken together” the R groups and the atoms they are attached to can form a cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl or heterocycle.
  • R d and R b of an NR d R b group are indicated to be "taken together," it means that they are covalently bonded to one another to form a ring:
  • R groups may not be limited to the variables or substituents defined previously.
  • trihalomethanesulfonyl trihalomethanesulfonamido, an amino, a mono-substituted amino group and a di -substituted amino group.
  • C a to CV' in which "a " and “b” are integers refer to the number of carbon atoms in an alkyl, alkenyl or alkynyl group, or the number of carbon atoms in the ring of a cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaiyl or heterocyclyl group. That is, the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, ring(s) of the cycloalkyl, ring(s) of the cycloalkenyl, ring(s) of the aryl, ring(s) of the heteroary!
  • a "C i to C4 alkyl” group refers to all alkyl groups having from 1 to 4 carbons, that is, CH -, CH CH 2 -, CH 3 CH 2 CH 2 -, (CH 3 ) 2 CH-, CH 3 CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 -, CH 3 CH 2 CH(CH 3 )- and (CH 3 ) 3 C-.
  • ''alkyl refers to a straight or branched hydrocarbon chain that comprises a fully saturated (no double or triple bonds) hydrocarbon group.
  • the alkyl group may have 1 to 20 carbon atoms (whenever it appears herein, a numerical range such as ; 'l to 20" refers to each integer in the given range; e.g. , " ⁇ to 20 carbon atoms” means that the alkyl group may consist of 1 carbon atom, 2 carbon atoms, 3 carbon atoms, etc. , up to and including 20 carbon atoms, although the present definition also covers the occurrence of the term "alkyl" where no numerical range is designated).
  • the alkyl group may also be a medium size alkyl having 1 to 10 carbon atoms.
  • the alkyl group could also be a lower alkyl having 1 to 6 carbon atoms.
  • the alkyl group of the compounds may be designated as "C 1 -C4 alkyl " or similar designations.
  • “C 1 -C4 alkyl” indicates that there are one to four carbon atoms in the alkyl chain, i.e., the alkyl chain is selected from methyl, ethyl, propyl, iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, sec-butyl, and t-butyl.
  • Typical alkyl groups include, but are in no way limited to, methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, isobutyl, tertiary butyl, pentyl (straight and branched) and hexyl (straight and branched).
  • the alkyl group may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • alkeny l refers to an alkyl group that contains in the straight or branched hydrocarbon chain one or more double bonds.
  • alkenyl groups include allenyl. vinylmethyl and ethenyl.
  • An alkenyl group may be unsubstituted or substituted.
  • alkyny refers to an alkyl group that contains in the straight or branched hydrocarbon chain one or more triple bonds. Examples of alkynyls include ethynyl and propynyl. An alkynyl group may be unsubstituted or substituted.
  • cycloalkyl refers to a completely saturated (no double or triple bonds) mono- or multi-cyclic hydrocarbon ring system. When composed of two or more rings, the rings may be joined together in a fused fashion. Cycloalkyl groups can contain 3 to 10 atoms in the ring(s) or 3 to 8 atoms in the ring(s). A cycloalkyl group may be unsubstituted or substituted. Typical cycloalkyl groups include, but are in no way limited to, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl and cyclooctyl.
  • cycloalkenyp refers to a mono- or multi-cyclic hydrocarbon ring system that contains one or more double bonds in at least one ring; although, if there is more than one, the double bonds cannot form a fully delocahzed pi- electron system throughout all the rings (otherwise the group would be "aryl, " ' as defined herein). When composed of two or more rings, the rings may be connected together in a fused fashion.
  • a cycloalkenyl can contain 3 to 10 atoms in the ring(s) or 3 to 8 atoms in the ring(s).
  • a cycloalkenyl group may be unsubstituted or substituted.
  • aryl refers to a carbocyclic (all carbon) mono-cyclic or multi-cyclic aromatic ring system (including fused ring systems where two carbocyclic rings share a chemical bond) that has a fully delocalized pi-electron system throughout all the rings.
  • the number of carbon atoms in an aryl group can vary.
  • the aryl group can be a C C 14 aryl group, a C 6 -C
  • aryl groups include, but are not limited to, benzene, naphthalene and azulene.
  • An aryl group may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • heteroaryl refers to a mono-cyclic or multi-cyclic aromatic ring system (a ring system with fully delocalized pi-electron system) that contain(s) one or more heteroatoms (for example, 1 to 5 heteroatoms), that is, an element other than carbon, including but not limited to. nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur.
  • the number of atoms in the ring(s) of a heteroaryl group can vary.
  • the heteroaryl group can contain 4 to 14 atoms in the ring(s). 5 to 10 atoms in the ring(s) or 5 to 6 atoms in the ring(s).
  • heteroaryl includes fused ring systems where two rings, such as at least one aryl ring and at least one heteroaryl ring, or at least two heteroaryl rings, share at least one chemical bond.
  • heteroaryl rings include, but are not limited to, furan, furazan, thiophene, benzothiophene, phthalazine, pyrrole, oxazole, benzoxazole, 1 ,2,3-oxadiazole, 1 ,2.4-oxadiazole, thiazole, 1 ,2,3 -thiadiazole, 1 ,2,4-thiadiazole, benzothiazole, imidazole, benzimidazole, indole, indazole, pyrazole, benzopyrazole, isoxazole.
  • a heteroary l group may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • heterocyclyl or “heteroalicyclyl” refers to three-, four-, five-, six-, seven-, eight-, nine-, ten-, up to 1 8-membered mono-cyclic, bicyclic, and tricyclic ring system wherein carbon atoms together with from 1 to 5 heteroatoms constitute said ring system.
  • a heterocycle may optionally contain one or more unsaturated bonds situated in such a way, however, that a fully delocalized pi-electron system does not occur throughout all the rings.
  • the heteroatom(s) is an element other than carbon including, but not limited to. oxygen, sulfur, and nitrogen.
  • a heterocycle may further contain one or more carbonyl or thiocarbonyl functionalities, so as to make the definition include oxo-systems and thio- systems such as lactams, lactones, cyclic imides, cyclic thioimides and cyclic carbamates. When composed of two or more rings, the rings may be joined together in a fused fashion. Additionally, any nitrogens in a heterocyclyl or a heteroalicyclyl may be quaternized. Heterocyclyl or heteroalicyclic groups may be unsubstituted or substituted. Examples of such "heterocyclyl" or “heteroalicyclyi' " groups include but are not limited to.
  • thiazolidine morpholine, oxirane, piperidine ⁇ -Oxide.
  • piperidine piperazine, pyrrolidine, pyrrolidone, pyrrolidione, 4-piperidone, pyrazolone, pyrazolidine, 2-oxopyrrolidine.
  • aralkyl and aryl(alkyl) refer to an aryl group connected, as a substituent, via a lower alkylene group.
  • the lower alkylene and/or aryl group of an aryi(alkyl) may be substituted or unsubstituted. Examples include but are not limited to benzyl, 2-phenyi(alkyi), 3-phenyl(alkyl), and naphthyl(alkyl).
  • heteroaryl(alkyl) refers to a heteroaryl group connected, as a substituent, via a lower alkylene group.
  • the lower alkylene and/or heteroaryl group of heteroaryl(alkyl) may be substituted or unsubstituted. Examples include but are not limited to 2-thienyl(alkyl), 3-thienyl(alkyT). furyl(alkyl), thienyl(alkyl), pyrrolyl(alkyl), pyridyl(alkyl), isoxazolyl(alkyl), imidazolyl(alkyl), and their benzo-fused analogs.
  • heteroalicyclyl(alkyl) and “heterocyclyKalkyl)” refer to a heterocyclic or a heteroalicyclylic group connected, as a substituent. via a lower alkylene group.
  • the lower alkylene and/or heterocyclyl of a heterocyclyl(alkyl) may be substituted or unsubstituted. Examples include but are not limited tetrahydro-2H-pyran-4-yl(methyl), piperidin-4-yl(ethyl). piperidin-4-yl(piOpyl), tetrahydro-2H-thiopyran-4-yl(methy ), and l ,3-thiazinan-4-yl(methyl).
  • “Lower alkylene groups” are straight-chained -CH 2 - tethering groups, forming bonds to connect molecular fragments via their terminal carbon atoms. Examples include but are not limited to methylene (-CH 2 -), ethylene (-CH 2 CH 2 -), propylene (- CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 -), and butylene (-CH 2 CH 2 CH 2 CIT 2 -).
  • alkoxy refers to the formula -OR wherein R is alky], alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, cycloalkyl(alkyl), aryl(alkyl). heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl) is defined herein.
  • R is alky
  • alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, cycloalkyl(alkyl), aryl(alkyl). heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl) is defined herein.
  • alkoxys are methoxy.
  • n-propoxy 1 -methylethoxy (isopropoxy)
  • n-butoxy iso-butoxy. sec-butoxy, tert-butoxy. phenoxy and benzoxy.
  • An alkoxy may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • acyl refers to a hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, or aryl connected, as substituents, via a carbonyl group. Examples include formyl, acetyl, propanoyl. benzoyl and acryl. An acyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • haloalkyl refers to an alkyl group in which one or more of the hydrogen atoms are replaced by a halogen (e.g., mono-haloalkyl, di-haloalkyl and tri- haloalkyl).
  • a halogen e.g., mono-haloalkyl, di-haloalkyl and tri- haloalkyl.
  • groups include but are not limited to, chloromethyl, iluoromethyl, dilluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl, l -chloiO-2-fluoromethyl and 2-fluoroisobutyl.
  • a haloalkyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • haloalkoxy refers to an alkoxy group of the formula -O- alkyi in which one or more of the hydrogen atoms are replaced by a halogen (e.g., mono- haloalkoxy, di- haloalkoxy and tri- haloalkoxy ).
  • a halogen e.g., mono- haloalkoxy, di- haloalkoxy and tri- haloalkoxy
  • Such groups include but are not limited to, chloromethoxy, fluoromcthoxy, difluoromethoxy, trifluoromethoxy.
  • l -chloro-2- fluoromethoxy and 2-fluoroisobutoxy include but are not limited to, chloromethoxy, fluoromcthoxy, difluoromethoxy, trifluoromethoxy.
  • l -chloro-2- fluoromethoxy and 2-fluoroisobutoxy e.g., 2-fluoroisobutoxy.
  • a “sulfenyr group refers to an "-SR " group in which R can be hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl. aryl. heteroaryl. heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl). heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl).
  • R can be hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl. aryl. heteroaryl. heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl). heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl).
  • a sulfenyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • a sulfinyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • a "sulfonyl” group refers to an "SC R " group in w hich R can be the same as defined with respect to sulfenyl.
  • a sulfonyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • An O-carboxy may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • a thiocarbonyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • a "trihalomethanesulfonyl” group refers to an "X 3 CS0 2 -" group wherein each X is a halogen.
  • a "trihalomethanesulfonamido" group refers to an "X 3 CS(0) 2 N(R A )- *" group wdierein each X is a halogen, and A is hydrogen, alkyl. alkenyl. alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl) .
  • amino refers to a -NH 2 group.
  • hydroxy refers to a -OH group.
  • a "cyano" group refers to a "-CN" * group.
  • An "isocyanato" group refers to a "- CO” group.
  • a "thiocyanato" group refers to a "-CNS” group.
  • S-sulfonamido refers to a "-S0 2 N(R A R B )" group in which R A and R R can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl. aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl).
  • R A and R R can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl. aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl).
  • An S-sulfonamido may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • N-sulfonamido refers to a "RS0 2 N(R A )-" group in which R and R A can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkeny l, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl. aryl(alky ), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocycly (alkyl).
  • R and R A can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkeny l, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl. aryl(alky ), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocycly (alkyl).
  • An N-sulfonamido may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • An O-carbamyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • R and RA can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkeny l, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl).
  • An N-carbamyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • An O-thiocarbamyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • N-thiocarbamyl refers to an group in which R and RA can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl).
  • R and RA can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl).
  • An N-thiocarbamy! may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • a C-amido may be substituted or unsubstituted.
  • R and RA can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkeny l, alkynyl. cycloalkyl, cycloalkeny l, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl). heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl).
  • R and RA can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkeny l, alkynyl. cycloalkyl, cycloalkeny l, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl). heteroaryl
  • halogen atom or halogen as used herein, means any one of the radio-stable atoms of column 7 of the Periodic Table of the Elements, such as, fluorine, chlorine, bromine and iodine.
  • substituents there may be one or more substituents present.
  • haloalkyl may include one or more of the same or different halogens.
  • -Cj alkoxyphenyl may include one or more of the same or different alkoxy groups containing one, two or three atoms.
  • protecting group and “protecting groups” as used herein refer to any atom or group of atoms that is added to a molecule in order to prevent existing groups in the molecule from undergoing unwanted chemical reactions.
  • Examples of protecting group moieties are described in T. W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, 3. Ed. John Wiley & Sons. 1999, and in J.F.W. McOmie, Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry Plenum Press, 1973, both of which are hereby incorporated by reference for the limited purpose of disclosing suitable protecting groups.
  • the protecting group moiety may be chosen in such a way, that they are stable to certain reaction conditions and readily removed at a convenient stage using methodology known from the art.
  • a non-limiting list of protecting groups include benzyl; substituted benzyl; alkylcarbonyls and alkoxycarbonyls (e.g., t-butoxycarbonyl (BOC), acetyl and isobutyryl); arylalkylcarbonyls and arylalkoxycarbonyls (e.g., benzyloxycarbonyl); substituted methyl ether (e.g. methoxymethyl ether and tetrahydropyranyl ether); substituted ethyl ether; a substituted benzyl ether; silyls (e.g.. trimethylsilyl, triethylsilyl. triisopropylsilyl.
  • alkylcarbonyls and alkoxycarbonyls e.g., t-butoxycarbonyl (BOC), acetyl and isobutyryl
  • esters e.g. benzoate ester
  • carbonates e.g. methoxymethylcarbonate
  • sulfonates e.g. tosylate and mesylate
  • acyclic ketal e.g.
  • cyclic ketals e.g., 1 ,3- dioxane and 1 ,3-dioxolane
  • acyclic acetal cyclic acetal; acyclic hemiacetal; cyclic hemiacetal; dithioacetals (both cyclic and acyclic); dithioketals (both cyclic and acyclic) (e.g.. S ⁇ -dimethyl, S.S " -diethyl. S.S " -diispropyl, 1 ,3-dithiane and 1 ,3-dithiolane); orthoesters (including cyclic orthoesters.
  • cyclic orthoformates such as cyclic orthoformates); carbamates (e.g., N- phenylcarbamate) and triary!methyl groups (e.g., trityl, monomethoxytrityl (MMTr). 4,4'- dimethoxytrityi (DMTr). and 4,4',4"-trimethoxytrityl (TMTr); and those described herein).
  • carbamates e.g., N- phenylcarbamate
  • triary!methyl groups e.g., trityl, monomethoxytrityl (MMTr). 4,4'- dimethoxytrityi (DMTr). and 4,4',4"-trimethoxytrityl (TMTr); and those described herein).
  • leaving group * refers to any atom or moiety that is capable of being displaced by another atom or moiety in a chemical reaction. More specifically, in some embodiments, “leaving group” refers to the atom or moiety that is displaced in a nucleophilic substitution reaction. In some embodiments, “leaving groups * ' are any atoms or moieties that are conjugate bases of strong acids. Examples of suitable leaving groups include, but are not limited to. tosylates, mesylates, trifluoroacetates and halogens (e.g.. I, Br, and CI). Non-limiting characteristics and examples of leaving groups can be found, for example in Organic Chemistry, 2d ed..
  • salt refers to a salt of a compound that does not cause significant irritation to an organism to which it is administered and does not abrogate the biological activity and properties of the compound.
  • the salt is an acid addition salt of the compound.
  • Pharmaceutical salts can be obtained by reacting a compound with inorganic acids such as hydrohalic acid (e.g., hydrochloric acid or hydrobromic acid), sulfuric acid, nitric acid and phosphoric acid.
  • Pharmaceutical salts can also be obtained by reacting a compound with an organic acid such as aliphatic or aromatic carboxylic or sulfonic acids, for example formic, acetic, succinic, lactic, malic, tartaric, citric, ascorbic, nicotinic, methanesulfonic, ethanesulfonic. p-toluensulfonic. salicylic or naphthalenesulfonic acid.
  • an organic acid such as aliphatic or aromatic carboxylic or sulfonic acids, for example formic, acetic, succinic, lactic, malic, tartaric, citric, ascorbic, nicotinic, methanesulfonic, ethanesulfonic.
  • p-toluensulfonic salicylic or naphthalenesulfonic acid.
  • Pharmaceutical salts can also be obtained by reacting a compound with a base to form a salt such as an ammonium salt, an alkali metal salt, such as a sodium or a potassium salt, an alkaline earth metal salt, such as a calcium or a magnesium salt, a salt of organic bases such as dicyclohexylamine, N-methyl-D-glucamine. tris(hydroxymethyl)methylamine, C]-Cy alkylamine. cyclohexylamine. triethanolamine. ethyienediamine, and salts with amino acids such as arginine and lysine.
  • a salt such as an ammonium salt, an alkali metal salt, such as a sodium or a potassium salt, an alkaline earth metal salt, such as a calcium or a magnesium salt, a salt of organic bases such as dicyclohexylamine, N-methyl-D-glucamine. tris(hydroxymethyl)methylamine, C]-Cy alkylamine. cyclohex
  • the term “comprising” is to be interpreted synonymously with the phrases “having at least” or “including at least”.
  • the term “comprising” means that the process includes at least the recited steps, but may include additional steps.
  • the term “comprising” means that the compound, composition or device includes at least the recited features or components, but may also include additional features or components.
  • a group of items linked with the conjunction 'and ' should not be read as requiring that each and every one of those items be present in the grouping, but rather should be read as 'and/or' unless expressly stated otherwise.
  • a group of items linked with the conjunction 'or' should not be read as requiring mutual exclusivity among that group, but rather should be read as 'and/or " unless expressly stated otherwise.
  • each center may independently be of R-configiiration or S-configuration or a mixture thereof.
  • the compounds provided herein may be enantiomerically pure, enantiomerically enriched, raccmic mixture, diastereomcrically pure, diastereomcrically enriched, or a stereoisomeric mixture.
  • each double bond may independently be E or Z a mixture thereof.
  • valencies are to be filled with hydrogens or isotopes thereof, e.g.. hydrogen- 1 (protium) and hydrogen-2 (deuterium).
  • each chemical element as represented in a compound structure may include any isotope of said element.
  • a hydrogen atom may be explicitly disclosed or understood to be present in the compound.
  • the hydrogen atom can be any isotope of hydrogen, including but not limited to hydrogen- 1 (protium) and hydrogen-2 (deuterium).
  • reference herein to a compound encompasses all potential isotopic forms unless the context clearly dictates otherwise.
  • the methods and combinations described herein include crystalline forms (also known as polymorphs, which include the different crystal packing arrangements of the same elemental composition of a compound), amorphous phases, salts, solvates, and hydrates.
  • the compounds described herein exist in solvated forms with pharmaceutically acceptable solvents such as water, ethanol. or the like.
  • the compounds described herein exist in unsolvated form.
  • Solvates contain either stoichiometric or non-stoichiometric amounts of a solvent, and may be formed during the process of crystallization with pharmaceutically acceptable solvents such as water, ethanol, or the like. Hydrates are formed when the solvent is water, or alcoholates are formed when the solvent is alcohol.
  • the compounds provided herein can exist in unsolvated as well as solvated forms. In general, the solvated forms are considered equivalent to the unsolvated forms for the purposes of the compounds and methods provided herein.
  • Some embodiments disclosed herein relate to a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically accept
  • R can be a single bond or double bond;
  • R 2 can be selected from hydrogen, an optionally substituted C
  • R JA and R JH can be independently hydrogen or an optionally substituted C alkyl;
  • R 4 and R 3 can be independently selected from hydrogen, an optionally substituted aryl, an optionally substituted aryl(Ci -6 alkyl) an optionally substituted heteroaryl and an optionally substituted heteroaiyl(Ci. 6 alkyl).
  • R 4 and R 3 can be taken together to form an optionally substituted tricyclic cycloalkenyl or an optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl
  • R 6 can be selected from hydrogen, halogen, -CM, an optionally substituted Ci -6 alkyl, an optionally substituted aryl, an optionally substituted heteroaryl, -CH 2 OH, -CH(Y 2 )(OH) and -C(0)Y 2
  • ⁇ ' and Y 2 can be independently selected from an optionally substituted C
  • R' and R° can be independently hydrogen or an optionally substituted C alkyl.
  • R 4 can be hydrogen.
  • R 4 can be an optionally substituted aryl, such as an optionally substituted pheny l or an optionally substituted naphthyl. When the pheny l ring is substituted, it can be substituted 1 , 2, or 3 or more times.
  • R 4 is a mono-substituted phenyl, the mono-substituted phenyl can be ortho-substituted. meta-substituted or para- substituted.
  • R 4 can be an optionally substituted aryl(Ci -6 alkyl).
  • R 4 can be an optionally substituted benzyl.
  • the phenyl ring of the benzyl group can be unsubstituted or substituted 1 , 2, or 3 or more times.
  • R 4 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl.
  • R 4 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl(C
  • heteroaryl ring of an optionally substituted heteroaryl and an optionally substituted heteroaryl(C i -6 alkyl) can be unsubstituted or substituted with 1 , 2 or 3 or more substituents.
  • R s can be an optionally substituted aryl.
  • R ""1 can be an optionally substituted phenyl or an optionally substituted naphthyl.
  • R 3 is a mono-substituted phenyl
  • the mono- substituted phenyl can be ortho-substituted, meta-substituted or para-substituted.
  • R 5 can be an optionally substituted aryl(C
  • R 4 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl.
  • R 4 can be an optionally substituted pyridinyl. an optionally substituted imidazolyl or an optionally substitute pyrazolyl.
  • R 4 is an optionally substituted heteroaryl(Ci -6 alkyl). When substituted, the optionally substituted heteroaryl and the optionally substituted heteroaryl(C
  • R 4 and/or R ? can be substituted with one or more substituents selected from halo (such as fluoro, chloro and iodo).
  • C alkyl for example, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl. iso-propyl. n-butyl. iso-butyl. tert-butyl).
  • R 4 and R ⁇ can each be an optionally substituted phenyl.
  • R 4 and R ? can be each a substituted phenyl substituted with one or more group selected from halo (such as fluoro, chloro and iodo).
  • C alkyl for example, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl. iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, tert-butyl).
  • cyclopropoxy and and an optionally substituted aryl for example, an optionally substituted phenyl
  • aryl for example, an optionally substituted phenyl
  • cyano for example, NC(C alkyl) (for example, NC-(CH 2 )-), 0-amido(C
  • R 4 and R ? can each be a deuterated pheny l.
  • the deuteratd phenyl can include one or more deuteriums (for example, 1 . 2. 3, 4 or 5 deuteriums).
  • R 4 and R ⁇ can be the same.
  • R 4 and R D can both be an unsubstituted phenyl.
  • R 4 and R 3 can be different.
  • R 4 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl (such as an optionally substituted mono-cyclic heteroaryl), and R 3 can be an optionally substituted aryl (such as an optionally substituted phenyl).
  • R 4 can be an optionally substituted aryl (such as an optionally substituted phenyl), and R 1 can be an optionally substituted aryl(C
  • R 4 and R J can be taken together to form a tricyclic ring group.
  • R 4 and R ? can be taken together to form an optionally substituted tricyclic cycloalkenyl.
  • R 4 and R ? can be taken together to form an optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl.
  • One. two or more than to heteroatoms can be present in the optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl such as nitrogen (N).
  • the optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl can be two aryl rings and one heterocyclyl ring, wherein the aryl rings can be the same or different.
  • the optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl can be two heteroaryl rings and one cycloalkenyl ring, wherein the heteroaryl rings can be the same or different; one aryl ring, one cycloalkenyl ring and one heterocyclyl ring; two heterocyclyl rings and one cycloalkenyl or cycloalkyl ring.
  • one or more of the rings of the optionally substituted tricyclic cycloalkenyl and/or the optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl can be substituted one or more times.
  • Various groups can be substituted on an optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl. such as halogen (such as fliioro, chloro and iodo) and/or C alkyl (for example, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl. iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl and tert-butyl).
  • halogen such as fliioro, chloro and iodo
  • C alkyl for example, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl. iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl and tert-butyl.
  • R " can be hydrogen. In other embodiments, R can be an optionally substituted Ci -6 alkyl. In some embodiments. R" can be an unsubstituted C j_ alkyl. The C i -6 alkyl can be methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl. n-butyl, iso-butyl, tert-butyl. pentyl (straight or branched) or hexyl (straight or branched). In some embodiments, R" can be a substituted C
  • the substituted Ci -6 alkyl of R " can be substituted one or more times with a substituents selected from halogen, haloalkyl (such as CF 3 ), hydroxy and alkoxy.
  • the one or more substituents on R 2 may not be present on the carbon closest to the nitrogen of the fused ring system.
  • R2 is substituted at the carbon attached to the carbon closest to the nitrogen of the fused ring sy stem of Formula (T).
  • the carbon may be a chiral center.
  • the chiral center can be a (S)-chiral center.
  • the chiral center can be a (7?)-chiral center.
  • R ⁇ can be an optionally substituted cycloalkyl(Ci -6 alkyl).
  • " can be an optionally substituted heterocyclyl.
  • R" can be an optionally substituted aryl(C
  • the phenyl ring of the benzyl ring can be substituted 1 , 2 or 3 or more times. When the phenyl ring of the benzyl group is mono-substituted, the phenyl ring can be substituted at the ortho-, meta- or para-position.
  • R 2 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl(C 1 -6 alkyl). In yet still other embodiments, R 2 can be an optionally substituted heterocyclyl(C i -6 alkyl). Examples of R 2 groups include, but are not
  • R 1 can be hydrogen.
  • R 1 can be an unsubstituted C alkyl.
  • R 1 can be methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl and t-butyi.
  • R 1 can be a group that in vivo is capable of providing a compound of Formula (I), wherein R 1 is hydrogen or absent. Those skilled in the art understand that when R 1 is absent, the oxygen adjacent to R 1 can possess as associated negative charge.
  • R can be a group that is enzymatically cleaved to provide a compound of Formula (1). w herein R 1 is hydrogen or absent.
  • Y 1 can be a variety of substituents.
  • Y 1 can be a substituted Ci -6 alkyl.
  • Y 1 can be an unsubstituted C i -6 alkyl.
  • Y 1 can be a substituted C 3 . 6 cycloalkyl.
  • Y 1 can be an unsubstituted C 3-6 cycloalkyl.
  • Y 1 can be a substituted aryl (for example, a substituted phenyl).
  • Y 1 can be an unsubstituted aryl (for example, an unsubstituted phenyl).
  • Y 1 can be a substituted heteroaryl (such as a substituted mono-cyclic heteroaryl). In yet still other embodiments, Y 1 can be an unsubstituted heteroaryl (such as an unsubstituted heteroaryl). In some embodiments, Y 1 can be a substituted heterocyclyl (such as a substituted mono-cyclic heterocyclyl). In other embodiments, Y 1 can be an unsubstituted heterocyclyl (such as an unsubstituted heterocyclyl). In still other embodiments, Y 1 can be a mono-substituted amino group. For example, the mono-substituted amino group can be rein Het can be an optionally substituted
  • Example groups for R include, but are not limited to, the following
  • R 6 can be hydrogen. In other embodiments, R 6 can be halogen. In still other embodiments, R 6 can be -CN . In yet still other embodiments, R 6 can be an optionally substituted C
  • R 6 can be an optionally substituted aryl (such as a mono-, di- or 3 or more substituted phenyl). In other embodiments, R 6 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl. In still other embodiments. R 6 can be -CH 2 OH. -CH(Y 2 )(OH) or - C(0)Y 2 . In some embodiments, a portion of R 6 can be enzymatically cleaved to provide a compound of Formula (I), wherein OH or O " is present at R 6 .
  • R ',D and R 3B can be independently hydrogen or an optionally substituted C alkyl.
  • R 3A and R JB can be both hydrogen.
  • at least one of R ⁇ ,A and R ⁇ L can be an optionally substituted C M alkyl.
  • R " ' A and R 3B can be an unsubstituted or substituted C M alkyl.
  • R 3A and R 'LB can be both an unsubstituted C alkyl, for example, both R A and R , B can be methyl.
  • R A and R 1 1 can be the same.
  • R ,D and R ,B can be different.
  • ally examples of compounds of Formula (1) include the following:
  • a compound of Formula (I) can be an isotope of hydrogen, such as hydrogen-2 (deuterium).
  • a compound of Formula (I) can be a compound of Formula (la).
  • _ 6 alkyl. In other embodiments of Table A, R 1 can be -C( 0)C i -6 alkyl and R 2 can be an unsubstituted
  • R 1 can be and R can be isopropyl.
  • R and/or R " can include one or more deuterium atoms.
  • R and/or R " can include one or more deuterium atoms.
  • R can be deuterium or R can and/or R ⁇ can be -CH(CH )(CD ) or R * can be -CH(CH 3 )(CD 3 ).
  • Intermediate A or Intermediate B can be coupled with a 1 ,2-amino alcohol.
  • suitable reaction conditions for coupling the aforementioned intermediate with a 1 ,2-amino alcohol include, but are not limited to, a carbodiimide (for example, N N'-dicyclohexylcarbodiimide (DCC), ⁇ , ⁇ '- diisopropylcarbodiimidc (DIC) or l -ethyl-3-(3-dimcthylaminopropyl)carbodiimide (EDCI)); 0-(7-azabenzotriazol- l -y -N.N Y'.N'-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate (HATU), O- benzotriazole-N,N,N'.N'-tetramethyl-uronimn-hexafluoro-phosphate (HBTU) or O- (benzotriazol-l -
  • DCC N N'-dicy
  • the hydrogen of the unprotected secondary 7 alcohol of compound a can be replaced to provide a suitable leaving group moiety.
  • Suitable leaving groups are known to those skilled in the art.
  • the leaving group can be 1, Br, CI, a mesyl moiety and/or a tosyl moiety.
  • the PG 1 and the SEM group attached to the nitrogen of compound b can be removed using methods known to those skilled in the art.
  • the benzyl group can be removed via hydrogenolysis.
  • Hydrogenolysis can be accomplished using various methods, such as a Pd or Pt catalyst (e.g., Pd/C or Pt0 ) in combination with a hydrogen source (e.g., I I2 or formic acid), a strong acid, oxidation to the benzoate and subsequent hydrolysis under basic conditions and 2,3-dichloro-5,6-dicyano-/?-benzoquinone (DDQ).
  • a Pd or Pt catalyst e.g., Pd/C or Pt0
  • a hydrogen source e.g., I I2 or formic acid
  • DDQ 2,3-dichloro-5,6-dicyano-/?-benzoquinone
  • the SEM group(s) can be removed using concentrated HF, tetra-n-butylammonium fluoride (TBAF). cesium fluoride, lithium tetrafluoroborate. trifluoroacetic acid (TFA) or pyridinium p-toluene sulfonate in ethanol at reflux temperature.
  • TBAF tetra-n-butylammonium fluoride
  • cesium fluoride lithium tetrafluoroborate.
  • the leaving group moiety, OLG 1 . can be removed and the compound can undergo cyclization using an acid or a base to form a compound of Formula (1).
  • Suitable acids and bases are known to those skilled in the art.
  • the base can be potassium carbonate.
  • Additional bases include sodium carbonate, calcium carbonate, cesium carbonate, sodium bicarbonate, potassium bicarbonate, calcium carbonate, cesium carbonate, triethylamine, diisopropyl ethyl amine, pyridine, KOH and NaOH.
  • Suitable acids include sulfonic acids (e.g., methane sulfonic acid and p-toluenesulfonic acid), trifluoroacetic acid (TFA) and HQ.
  • the reagent(s) used to remove the PG 1 and SEM groups for example, cesium fluoride or tetra-n-butylammonium fluoride (TBAF), can then promote cyclization to a compound of Formula (I).
  • cesium fluoride or tetra-n-butylammonium fluoride (TBAF) can then promote cyclization to a compound of Formula (I).
  • the PG 1 and the SEM groups attached to the nitrogen can be removed from compound d using one or more methods described herein.
  • a compound of Formula (T) can be then formed via a Mitsunobu ring-closure cyclization.
  • the Mitsunobu ring-closure cyclization can be accomplished using a phosphine reagent (for example, triphenylphosphine. a tri-alkyl phosphine. a tri-aryl phosphine or polymer-supported triphenylphosphine) in combination with an azodicarboxylate. such as diethyl azodicarboxylate (DEAD) or diisopropyl azodicarboxylate (DIAD).
  • DEAD diethyl azodicarboxylate
  • DIAD diisopropyl azodicarboxylate
  • the PG 1 and the SEM groups can be removed and the ring closed to form a compound of Formula (1) in a single step using a
  • compound a can be formed as described herein.
  • the secondary alcohol can be oxidized to a ketone using reagent(s) and conditions known to those skilled in the art.
  • suitable oxidizing reagents and conditions include, but arc not limited to. Dess-Martin periodinane. 1BX (2-iodoxybenzoic acid), TPAP/NMO (tetrapropylammonium perruthenate/N-methylmorpholine N-oxide). Swern oxidation reagent, PCC (pyridinium chlorochromate). PDC (pyridinium dichromate), sodium periodate.
  • the PG 1 and the SEM group attached to the nitrogen can be removed using one or more methods described herein to provide compound g.
  • the six-membered ring can be formed under acidic condition to provide a compound of Formula (I), wherein is a double bond.
  • suitable acids include, but are not limited to, sulfonic acids (e.g., methane sulfonic acid and p-toluenesulfonic acid), sulfuric acid, trifluoroacetic acid (TFA) and HC1.
  • the double bond can be hydrogenated to a single bond using hydrogen gas in the presence of a palladium or platinum catalyst (such as Pd/C or Pt0 2 ).
  • Amino alcohols that can be used in the preparation of a compound of Formula (I) can be commercially obtained or prepared according to a procedure provided herein, for example, a procedure shown in Schemes 4-6.
  • the ketone undergoes olefination using an alkoxy- based phosphonium halide under Wittig-type reaction conditions to form a vinyl alkoxy intermediate.
  • the vinyl alkoxy intermediate can be hydrolyzcd to an aldehyde using methods known to those skilled in the art. such as perchloric acid.
  • Nitromethane can be added to the aldehyde via a nitro-aldol reaction. Utilizing methods and conditions known to those skilled in the art, the nitro group can be reduced to a NH 2 group.
  • the NPF group can undergo reductive alkylation to form the amino alcohol.
  • Another method for forming the amino alcohol is shown in Scheme 5.
  • An amino acid ester can be added to the anion of the starting material, generated using a method known to those skilled in the art, for example, using n-BuLi.
  • the ketone can be reduced to a hydroxy group using one or more suitable reagents and conditions, such as those described herein.
  • the nitrogen of the amino acid ester can be protected with a suitable protecting group. The protecting group can be removed before or after reduction of the ketone using methods known to those skilled in the art.
  • Scheme 6 shows a further method for forming the amino alcohol.
  • the amino alcohol can be formed by a directed lithiation followed by a condensation-type reaction, using a method known to those skilled in the art, Snieckus et. al.. Tet. Lett. (1994) 35(24):4067-4070.
  • compositions that can include an effective amount of one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula ( ⁇ ), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, diluent, excipient or combination thereof.
  • compositions refers to a mixture of one or more compounds disclosed herein with other chemical components, such as diluents or carriers.
  • the pharmaceutical composition facilitates administration of the compound to an organism.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions can also be obtained by reacting compounds with inorganic or organic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, nitric acid, phosphoric acid, methanesulfonic acid, ethanesulfonic acid, p-toluenesulfonic acid, and salicylic acid.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions will generally be tailored to the specific intended route of administration.
  • physiologically acceptable defines a carrier, diluent or excipient that does not abrogate the biological activity and properties of the compound.
  • a “carrier” refers to a compound that facilitates the incorporation of a compound into cells or tissues.
  • DMSO dimethyl sulfoxide
  • DMSO dimethyl sulfoxide
  • a "diluent " ' refers to an ingredient in a pharmaceutical composition that lacks pharmacological activity but may be pharmaceutically necessary or desirable.
  • a diluent may be used to increase the bulk of a potent drug whose mass is too small for manufacture and/or administration. It may also be a liquid for the dissolution of a drug to be administered by injection, ingestion or inhalation.
  • a common form of diluent in the art is a buffered aqueous solution such as, w ithout limitation, phosphate buffered saline that mimics the composition of human blood.
  • an “excipient *” refers to an inert substance that is added to a pharmaceutical composition to provide, without limitation, bulk, consistency, stability, binding ability, lubrication, disintegrating ability etc., to the composition.
  • a “diluent” is a type of excipient.
  • compositions described herein can be administered to a human patient per se, or in pharmaceutical compositions where they are mixed with other active ingredients, as in combination therapy, or carriers, diluents, excipients or combinations thereof. Proper formulation is dependent upon the route of administration chosen. Techniques for formulation and administration of the compounds described herein are known to those skilled in the art.
  • compositions disclosed herein may be manufactured in a manner that is itself known, e.g.. by means of conventional mixing, dissolving, granulating, dragee-making, levigating, emulsifying, encapsulating, entrapping or tableting processes. Additionally, the active ingredients are contained in an amount effective to achieve its intended purpose. Many of the compounds used in the pharmaceutical combinations disclosed herein may be provided as salts with pharmaceutically compatible counterions.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g.. a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be administering intramuscular.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein can be administering intranasal.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein can be administering intradermal.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g.. a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be administering orally .
  • one or more compounds described herein can be formulated as tablets, pills, dragees. capsules, liquids, gels, syrups, slurries, suspensions and the like, for oral ingestion by a subject to be treated.
  • injectables can be prepared in conventional forms, either as liquid solutions or suspensions, solid forms suitable for solution or suspension in liquid prior to injection, or as emulsions.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions for intranasal delivery may also include drops and sprays often prepared to assist in simulating nasal secretions.
  • compositions may. if desired, be presented in a pack or dispenser device which may contain one or more unit dosage forms containing the active ingredient.
  • the pack may for example comprise metal or plastic foil, such as a blister pack.
  • the pack or dispenser device may be accompanied by instructions for administration.
  • the pack or dispenser may also be accompanied with a notice associated with the container in form prescribed by a governmental agency regulating the manufacture, use, or sale of pharmaceuticals, which notice is reflective of approval by the agency of the form of the drug for human or veterinary 7 administration. Such notice, for example, may be the labeling approved by the U.S. Food and Drug Administration for prescription drugs, or the approved product insert.
  • Compositions that can include a compound described herein formulated in a compatible pharmaceutical carrier may also be prepared, placed in an appropriate container, and labeled for treatment of an indicated condition.
  • Some embodiments described herein relate to a method of ameliorating, treating and/or preventing an orthomyxovirus infection, which can include administering an effective amount of one or more compounds described herein, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g.. a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof).
  • FIG. 14 Other embodiments described herein relate to a method of inhibiting an orthomyxovirus viral replication, which can include contacting a cell infected with the orthomyxovirus virus with an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereoi).
  • a method of inhibiting an orthomyxovirus viral replication which can include contacting a cell infected with the orthomyxovirus virus with an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereoi).
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein can be used to treat and/or ameliorate an influenza viral infection.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein can be used to prevent an influenza viral infection.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein can be used to inhibit the replication an influenza virus.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein can be used to inhibit the influenza polymerase complex.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein can be used for inhibiting and/or reducing the endonuclease activity of an influenza endonuclease that can include contacting the active site of the endonuclease with a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • one or more compounds described herein inhibits and/or reduces the ability of the endonuclease to cleave the mRNA.
  • influenza viral infection can be an influenza A viral infection.
  • influenza viral infection can be an influenza B viral infection.
  • influenza viral infection can be an influenza C viral infection.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be used to treat and/or ameliorate one or more subtypes of influenza.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be used to treat H 1N1 and/or H3N2.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be used to treat H2N2. H5N1 and/or H7N9.
  • a compound described herein (a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be effective against more than 1 subtype of influenza.
  • a compound described herein (a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be effective against 2. 3, 4, and/or 5 or more subtypes of influenza.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used treat and/or ameliorate an upper respiratory viral infection attributed to (directly and/or indirectly) an influenza virus infection.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein can be used treat and/or ameliorate a lower respiratory viral infection (directly and/or indirectly) an influenza virus infection.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein can be used treat and/or ameliorate one or more symptoms of an influenza virus infection (such as those described herein).
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein can be used treat and/or ameliorate bronchiolitis and/or tracheobronchitis due to an influenza virus infection.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein can be used treat and/or ameliorate pneumonia due to an influenza virus infection.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g.. a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used treat and/or ameliorate coup due to an influenza virus infection.
  • an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used lessen the severity of one or more symptoms of an influenza infection.
  • symptoms include, but are not limited to, the following: fever, chills, cough, sore throat, runny nose, stuffy nose, muscle aches, body aches, headache, fatigue, vomiting and/or diarrhea.
  • the terms “prevent” ' and “preventing, “ mean a subject does not develop an infection because the subject has an immunity against the infection, or if a subject becomes infected, the severity of the disease is less compared to the severity of the disease if the subject has not been administered/received the compound.
  • forms of prevention include prophylactic administration to a subject who has been or may be exposed to an infectious agent, such as an orthomyxovirus (e.g., an influenza virus).
  • treat do not necessarily mean total cure or abolition of the disease or condition. Any alleviation of any undesired signs or symptoms of a disease or condition, to any extent can be considered treatment and/or therapy. Furthermore, treatment may include acts that may worsen the subject ' s overall feeling of well-being or appearance.
  • a therapeutically effective amount of compound can be the amount needed to prevent, alleviate or ameliorate symptoms of disease or prolong the survival of the subject being treated This response may occur in a tissue, system, animal or human and includes alleviation of the signs or symptoms of the disease being treated. Determination of an effective amount is well within the capability of those skilled in the art, in view of the disclosure provided herein.
  • the therapeutically effective amount of the compounds disclosed herein required as a dose will depend on the route of administration, the type of animal, including human, being treated, and the physical characteristics of the specific animal under consideration. The dose can be tailored to achieve a desired effect, but will depend on such factors as weight, diet, concurrent medication and other factors which those skilled in the medical arts w ill recognize.
  • a "subject" refers to an animal that is the object of treatment, observation or experiment.
  • Animal includes cold- and warm-blooded vertebrates and invertebrates such as fish, shellfish, reptiles and. in particular, mammals.
  • mammal includes, without limitation, mice, rats, rabbits, guinea pigs, dogs, cats, sheep, goats, cows, horses, primates, such as monkeys, chimpanzees, and apes, and, in particular, humans. In some embodiments, the subject is human.
  • Suitable indicators include, but are not limited to, a reduction in viral load, a reduction in viral replication, a reduction in time to seroconversion (virus undetectable in patient serum), a reduction of morbidity or mortality in clinical outcomes, and/or other indicator of disease response.
  • an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof is an amount that is effective to reduce viral load compared to the viral load before administration of the compound of Formula ( ⁇ ), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be an amount that is effective to reduce viral load to lower than about 10E4 TCID50/mL.
  • an effective amount of a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof is an amount that is effective to achieve a reduction in viral titer in a nasal/pharyngeal swab or nasal wash sample of the subject in the range of about 1 .5-log to about a 2.5-log reduction or about a 3-log to about a 4-log reduction compared to the viral load before administration of the compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the viral load is measure before administration of the compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and again after initiation of the treatment regime with the compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof (for example, 10 days after initiation of treatment).
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing can result in one or more overall quality of life health, such as reduced illness duration, reduced illness severity, reduced time to return to normal health and normal activity, and reduced time to alleviation of one or more symptoms of orthomyxovirus infection, compared to a subject who is untreated.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing can result in a reduction in the length and/or severity of one or more symptoms associated with an orthomyxovirus infection compared to an untreated subject.
  • Symptoms of an orthomyxovirus infection include but not limited to cough, myalgia (muscle pain), nasal obstruction, sore throat, fatigue, headache and fever.
  • a compound of Formula ( ⁇ ), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the thereof can result in a reduction in one or more secondary complications associated with an orthomyxovirus infection, including but not limited to otitis media (ear inflammation), sinusitis, bronchitis and pneumonia compared to an untreated subject.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing can result in at least a 1 , 2, 3, 4, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 50, 75, 100-fold or more reduction in the replication of an orthomyxovirus relative to pre-treatment levels in a subject, as determined after initiation of the treatment regime (for example, 10 days after initiation of treatment).
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing can result in a reduction of the replication of an orthomyxovirus relative to pre -treatment levels in the range of about 2 to about 5 fold, about 10 to about 20 fold, about 15 to about 40 fold, or about 50 to about 100 fold.
  • a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can result in a reduction of orthomyxovirus replication in the range of 1 to 1 .5 log. 1 .5 log to 2 log. 2 log to 2.5 log, 2.5 to 3 log, or 3 to 3.5 log reduction of orthomyxovirus replication compared to the reduction of orthomyxovirus reduction achieved by oseltamivir (Tamiflu®). or may achieve the same reduction as that of oseltamivir (Tamiflu®) therapy in a shorter period of time, for example, in one day, two days, three days, or four days as compared to the reduction achieved after 5 days of oseltamivir (Tamiflu® ) therapy.
  • infectious agents can develop resistance to one or more therapeutic agents.
  • resistance refers to a viral strain displaying a delayed, lessened and/or null response to a therapeutic agent(s).
  • the viral load of a subject infected with a resistant virus may be reduced to a lesser degree compared to the amount in viral load reduction exhibited by a subject infected with a non-resistant strain.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be administered to a subject infected with an influenza virus that is resistant to one or more different anti- influenza agents (for example, amantadine, rimantadine and/or oseltamivir).
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be administered to a subject infected with an influenza virus that is resistant to a M2 protein inhibitor.
  • development of resistant influenza strains is delayed when subjects are treated with a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, compared to the development of influenza strains resistant to other influenza drugs.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can decrease the percentage of subjects that experience complications from an influenza viral infection compared to the percentage of subjects that experience complication being treated with oseltamivir.
  • the percentage of subjects being treated with a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, that experience complications can be 10%, 25%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80% and 90% less compared to subjects being treated with oseltamivir.
  • a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes a compound described herein can be used in combination with one or more additional agent(s).
  • a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be used in combination with one or more agents currently used in a conventional standard of care for treating influenza.
  • the additional agent can be amantadine (adamantan-
  • additional agents include but are not limited to a neuraminidase inhibitor, a M2 protein inhibitor, a polymerase inhibitor, a PB2 inhibitor, peramivir (( 1 S,2S,3S,4R)-3-[( 1 S)- 1 -acetamido-2-ethylbutyl]-4-(diaminomethyiideneamino)-
  • a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes a compound described herein can be used in combination with oseltamivir.
  • Type 1 interferons are known to those skilled in the art. A non-limiting list of examples include: alpha-interferons, beta-interferons, delta-interferons, omega- interferons, tau-interferons, x-interferons. consensus interferons and asialo-interferons. Type 1 interferons can be pegylated. Examples of specific type 1 interferons include interferon alpha 1 A, interferon alpha I B. interferon alpha 2A.
  • interferon alpha 2B pegylated-interferon alpha 2a (PEGASYS, Roche), recombinant interferon alpha 2a (ROFERON, Roche), inhaled interferon alpha 2b (AERX. Aradigm), pegylated-interferon alpha 2b (ALBUFERON, Human Genome Sciences/Novartis, PEGINTRON. Schering). recombinant interferon alpha 2b (INTRON A. Schering). pegylated interferon alpha 2b (PEG-INTRON. Schering, V1RAFERONPEG, Schering), interferon beta- la (REB1F, Serono, Inc. and Pfizer), consensus interferon alpha (1NFERGEN, Valeant Pharmaceutical).
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be administered with one or more additional agent(s) together in a single pharmaceutical composition.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be administered with one or more additional agent(s) as two or more separate pharmaceutical compositions.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be administered in one pharmaceutical composition, and at least one of the additional agents can be administered in a second pharmaceutical composition.
  • one or more of the additional agents can be in a first pharmaceutical composition that includes a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and at least one of the other additional agent(s) can be in a second pharmaceutical composition.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, with one or more additional agent(s) can vary.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be administered prior to all additional agents.
  • a compound of Formula ( ⁇ ), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be administered prior to at least one additional agent.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be administered concomitantly with one or more additional agent(s).
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be administered subsequent to the administration of at least one additional agent.
  • a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceuticallv acceptable salt thereof can be administered subsequent to the administration of all additional agents.
  • the combination of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more additional agent(s) can result in an additive effect. In some embodiments, the combination of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more additional agent(s) can result in a synergistic effect. In some embodiments, the combination of a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more additional agent(s) can result in a strongly synergistic effect. In some embodiments, the combination of a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more additional agent(s) is not antagonistic.
  • the term "antagonistic” means that the activity of the combination of compounds is less compared to the sum of the activities of the compounds in combination when the activity of each compound is determined individually (i.e. as a single compound).
  • the term “synergistic effect” means that the activity of the combination of compounds is greater than the sum of the individual activities of the compounds in the combination when the activity of each compound is determined individually.
  • the term “additive effect” means that the activity of the combination of compounds is about equal to the sum of the individual activities of the compound in the combination when the activity of each compound is determined individually.
  • a potential advantage of utilizing a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more of the additional agent(s) described above, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof may be a reduction in the required amount(s) of the one or more additional agents, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof, that is effective in treating a disease condition disclosed herein (for example, influenza), as compared to the amount required to achieve the same therapeutic result when one or more of the additional agents, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof, are administered without a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • a disease condition disclosed herein for example, influenza
  • the amount of an additional agent described above, including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt and prodrug thereof can be less when administered in combination with a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, compared to the amount of additional agent, including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt and prodrug thereof, needed to achieve the same viral load reduction when administered as a monotherapy.
  • Another potential advantage of utilizing a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more of the additional agent(s) described above, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof is that the use of two or more compounds having different mechanisms of action can create a higher barrier to the development of resistant viral strains compared to the barrier when a compound is administered as monotherapy.
  • Additional advantages of utilizing a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more of the additional agent(s) described above, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof may include little to no cross resistance between a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and the one or more additional agent(s) described above (including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof); different routes for elimination of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and the one or more additional agent(s) described above (including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof); little to no overlapping toxicities between a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and the one or more additional agent(s) described above (including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof); little to no significant effects on cytochrome P450; and/or little to no pharmacokinetic interactions between a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and the one or more additional agent(s) described above, including
  • the useful in vivo dosage to be administered and the particular mode of administration will vary depending upon the age, weight, the severity of the affliction, and mammalian species treated, the particular compounds employed, and the specific use for which these compounds are employed.
  • the determination of effective dosage levels that is the dosage levels necessary to achieve the desired result, can be accomplished by one skilled in the art using routine methods, for example, human clinical trials and in vitro studies.
  • the dosage may range broadly, depending upon the desired effects and the therapeutic indication. Alternatively dosages may be based and calculated upon the surface area of the patient, as understood by those of skill in the art. Although the exact dosage will be determined on a drug-by-drug basis, in most cases, some generalizations regarding the dosage can be made.
  • the daily dosage regimen for an adult human patient may be, for example, an oral dose of between 0.01 mg and 3000 mg of each active ingredient, preferably between 1 mg and 700 mg, e.g. 5 to 200 mg.
  • the dosage may be a single one or a series of two or more given in the course of one or more days, as is needed by the subject.
  • the compounds will be administered for a period of continuous therapy, for example for a week or more, or for months or years.
  • human dosages for compounds have been established for at least some condition, those same dosages may be used, or dosages that are between about 0.1 % and 500%. more preferably between about 25% and 250% of the established human dosage.
  • a suitable human dosage can be inferred from ED 50 or ID 5 o values, or other appropriate values derived from in vitro or in vivo studies, as qualified by toxicity studies and efficacy studies in animals.
  • dosages may be calculated as the free base.
  • Dosage amount and interval may be adjusted individually to provide plasma levels of the active moiety which are sufficient to maintain the modulating effects, or minimal effective concentration (MEC).
  • MEC minimal effective concentration
  • the MEC will vary for each compound but can be estimated from in vitro data. Dosages necessary to achieve the MEC will depend on individual characteristics and route of administration. However, HPLC assays or bioassays can be used to determine plasma concentrations.
  • Dosage intervals can also be determined using MEC value.
  • Compositions should be administered using a regimen which maintains plasma levels above the MEC for 1 0-90% of the time, preferably between 30-90% and most preferably between 50-90%.
  • the effective local concentration of the drug may not be related to plasma concentration.
  • the attending physician would know how 7 to and when to terminate, interrupt, or adjust administration due to toxicity or organ dysfunctions. Conversely, the attending physician would also know to adjust treatment to higher levels if the clinical response were not adequate (precluding toxicity).
  • the magnitude of an administrated dose in the management of the disorder of interest will vary with the severity of the condition to be treated and to the route of administration. The severity of the condition may . for example, be evaluated, in part, by standard prognostic evaluation methods. Further, the dose and perhaps dose frequency, will also vary according to the age. body weight, and response of the individual patient. A program comparable to that discussed above may be used in veterinary medicine.
  • Compounds disclosed herein can be evaluated for efficacy and toxicity using known methods.
  • the toxicology of a particular compound, or of a subset of the compounds, sharing certain chemical moieties may be established by determining in vitro toxicity towards a cell line, such as a mammalian, and preferably human, cell line. The results of such studies are often predictive of toxicity in animals, such as mammals, or more specifically, humans.
  • the toxicity of particular compounds in an animal model such as mice, rats, rabbits, or monkeys, may be determined using known methods.
  • the efficacy of a particular compound may be established using several recognized methods, such as in vitro methods, animal models, or human clinical trials. When selecting a model to determine efficacy, the skilled artisan can be guided by the state of the art to choose an appropriate model, dose, route of administration and/or regime.
  • Compound A-5 was prepared according to the procedure described in Gopishetty et. al.. Tetrahedron: Asymmetry (201 1 ) 22( 10): 1081 - 1086, which is hereby incorporated by reference for the limited purpose of its disclosure of the preparation of A-5.
  • Compound A-15 was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 6 (Route 2) and using (R)-ethyl 2-(5-(benzyloxy)-4-oxo-N-( l .l -trifluoropropan ⁇ - y -l - ⁇ - ⁇ rimethylsily ethoxy ⁇ methy -l ⁇ -d ⁇
  • alkyl alkyl
  • a round bottom flask was charged with A-7, polymer supported tri- phenylphosphine (2.75 equiv., 100-200 mesh, 3.2 mniol/g loading) and dry N-methyl-2- pyrrolidinone (NMP, 6.5 mL).
  • the flask was placed in an 85 "C oil bath and diisopropyl azodicarboxylate (DIAD, 2.5 eq.) was added via syringe in approximately 4 equal portions at 30 minute intervals.
  • the reaction was monitored by LCMS. The reaction was heated for a total of 2.5 h. then cooled to ambient temperature and diluted with 1 % MeOH/EtOAc (5 mL) and filtered through a plug of celite.
  • the resin was rinsed with 1 % MeOH/EtOAc (30 mL). The filtrate was shaken with an equal volume of 2% NH4CI (aq) in a separately funnel. The EtOAc phase was collected, and the aqueous phase was further extracted with EtOAc (3 x 20 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine, dried (MgS04). filtered and concentrated.
  • a solution of A-ll (130 mg, 0.19 mmol) in DCM (1 mL) was treated with TFA (1 mL), and the solution was stirred at RT for 2.5 h. The reaction was monitored by LCMS and shows both SEM groups were cleaved. The solution was concentrated under reduced pressure to give A-12, which was used without further purification.
  • the organic phase was dried over Na7S0 4 , filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give the crude (0.8 g).
  • the crude was purified by flash chromatography (Biotage KP-Sil l OOg SNAP cartridge, gradient cyclohexane:EA from 100:0 to 95:5 in 10CV, fraction size 42 mL) to give B-20 (0.52 g) as a yellow solid.
  • Nitric acid 1 10 mL was added dropwise at 0 °C to B-22 ( 10 g) over 2 h. The mixture was stirred at 0 °C for 2 h and then slowly poured into chilled water (700 mL). The precipitate obtained was filtered to give a pale yellow 7 solid (15.6 g). The solid was stirred in boiling in EtOH (2 x 40 mL) and filtered to give B-23 ( 12 g) as a pale yellow solid containing a mixture of 1 ,7- and 3,7-dinitro products that was used in the next step without further purification.
  • Compound B-25 (830 mg) was added to a suspension of CuCL (1 .87 g) and tert-butyl nitrite ( 1.25 mL) in dry CH 3 CN (21 mL) at 0 °C. The mixture was allowed to warm up at RT for 2.5 h, and then heated at 50 °C. After 21 h, C11CI2 and tert-butyl nitrite (same quantities as above) were added, and the mixture was heated again. After 25 h, a third addition of the same quantities of CuCL and tert-butyl nitrite was made. After 28 h, the mixture was diluted with CH 2 Cl 2 and filtered on a celite pad.
  • Amino alcohol AA10 was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 15 and using HBF 4 /NaNC>2.
  • l -(3-methoxyphenyl)-3-(methylamino)-l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3- methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methanone (prepared following step 1 of Example 5 using 3- methoxybenzoyl chloride and phenylboronic acid) and methylamine.
  • l -(3-methoxyphenyl)-3-(ethylamino)- l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3- and ethylamine.
  • l -(3-fluorophenyl)-3-(meth ⁇ iamino)- l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using (3- fluorophenyl)(phenyl)methanone (prepared following step 1 of Example 5 using 3- fluorobenzoyl chloride and phenylboronic acid) and methylamine.
  • l , l-bis(3-chlorophenyi)-3-(ethylamino)propan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3-chlorobenzoyl chloride and ethylamine.
  • l ,l -bis(3-chlorophenyl)-3-(propylamino)propan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3-chlorobenzoyl chloride and propylamine.
  • Triphenylphosphine (15.3 g. 58.37 mmol. 1 eq.) was diluted in MeOH (100 mL). 3-chlorobenzylchloride (9.4 g, 58.37 mmol, 1 eq.) diluted in MeOH (50 mL) was added dropwise to the stirred solution. The mixture was heated at reflux for 2 h. The mixture was cooled to 0 °C and 2-formylbenzoic acid (8.7 g, 58.37 mmol, 1 cq.) was added. Sodium methoxide (28% in MeOH; 28.0 g, 145 mmol, 2.5 eq.) was added dropwise at 0 °C.
  • Aryl bromide K-l (2 g, 8.73 mmol) and phenylboronic acid (1 .6 g, 13.1 mmol) were taken up in toluene (120 mL). To this mixture was added a solution of 2M sodium carbonate (50 mL). The flask was evacuated and back filled with Ar (3 cycles). Tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium (1 .01 g, 0.873 mmol) was added. The flask was evacuated and back filled with argon (3 cycles). The flask was placed in an oil bath heated to 80 °C and stirred overnight. The flask was cooled to ambient.
  • the mixture was diluted with EA and washed successively with water and a brine solution.
  • the crude product was purified by flash chromatography (25 g silica column, elution gradient 2% to 5% EA:hexanes) to provide K-2 as a light yellow oil (1.82 g).
  • Methyl ester K-2 (1.82 g, 8.05 mmol) was taken up in dry tetrahydrofuran (20 mL) and cooled in an ice bath under an Ar balloon. To this mixture was added a 1 M solution of lithium aluminum hydride in THF (9.7 ml, 9.66 mmol) via a slow dropwise addition over 5 mins. The mixture was stirred for 1 h at 0 °C. Water (0.16 mL) was added, and the mixture stirred for 10 mins. A solution of 5% NaOH (0.31 mL) was added, and the mixture stirred for 10 mins. Water (0.31 mL) was added, and the mixture stirred for 10 mins.
  • the mixture was dried via addition of powdered magnesium sulfate.
  • the mixture was filtered through a plug of eclite, rinsing with CH 2 CT 2 .
  • the filtrate was transferred to a separator ⁇ ' funnel and shaken with water.
  • the organic phase was collected, dried with magnesium sulfate and filtered.
  • the solvent removed to provide the intermediate alcohol ( 1 .519 g, semi-viscous white cloudy oil) which was used directly in the next step.
  • An oven dried flask containing oxalyl chloride (0.55 mL, 9.80 mmol) in dry CLLC ( 12 mL) was cooled to -78 °C under Ar.
  • the organic phase was collected and washed with a 50% diluted brine solution.
  • the organic phase was collected, dried with magnesium sulfate, filtered and stripped.
  • the crude remainder was purified by flash chromatography (25 g silica gel column, elution gradient 2% to 8% EA:hexanes) to provide K-3 as a pale yellow oil ( 179 mg).
  • Lhe EA phases were combined, dried with magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated.
  • Lhe crude product was purified by flash chromatography (25 g silica gel column, elution gradient 1 % to 6% EA:hexanes) to provide L-4 as a pale yellow oil (1 .04 g).
  • Trimethylsulfoxonium iodide ( 1 .03 g, 4.68 mmol) was added to a mixture of Nai l (95%; 1 12 mg, 4.6 mmol) in DMSO (8 mL) at RT. The mixture was stirred for 30 min, and then a solution of G-2 (0.75 g. 3.12 mmol) in DMSO (2 mL) was added. The solution was heated at 60 °C for 1 .5 h and then diluted with water (75 mL) and hexane (50 mL).
  • 129-3 (14.3 g), isopropylamine (22 mL, ⁇ 0.688; -3.9 eq.). and reagent alcohol (22 mL) were combined. The mixture was heated in a 65 -°C oil bath for 10 mins. and then sealed and stirred overnight. The mixture was concentrated, and then dissolved in EA (150 mL). Hydrogen chloride (4 M) in dioxane (20 mL) was added and the precipitated white hydrochloride salt that formed was filtered. washed with EA and dried at 70 °C to give 129-4 (9.12 g).
  • Human lung carcinoma A549 cells (ATCC, Manassas, VA) were plated at a density of 5 x 10 4 cells/mL (5 x 10 J cells/well) in assay media (Ham " s F12 media supplemented with 0.3% FBS, 1 % penicillin/streptomycin (all Mediatech. Manassas, VA) and 1 % DMSO (Sigma-Aldrich. St Louis. MO)) in black 96-well plates.
  • assay media Ham " s F12 media supplemented with 0.3% FBS, 1 % penicillin/streptomycin (all Mediatech. Manassas, VA) and 1 % DMSO (Sigma-Aldrich. St Louis. MO)
  • MDCK Madin-Darby canine kidney epithelial cells
  • ATCC ATCC
  • assay media DMRM supplemented with 0.3% FBS, 1 % penicillin/streptomycin and 1% DMSO
  • serially diluted test compounds were added to cells and incubated for an additional 24 hours.
  • Cells were infected with 250 lU/well of Influenza strain A549_A/WSN/33 (H1N 1) (Virapur, San Diego CA) and incubated for 20 hours at 37°C, 5% C0 2 .
  • the cell culture supernatant was aspirated off and 50 ⁇ L of 25 ⁇ 2 " -(4-Methylumbelliferyi)-a-D-N-acetyineuraminic acid (Sigma- Aldrich) dissolved in 33 mM MES, pH 6.5 (Emerald Biosystems, Bainbridge Island, WA) was added to the cells. After incubation for 45 min at 30°C, reactions were stopped by addition of 150 stop solution ( 100 mM glycine, pH 10.5, 25% ethanol, all Sigma- Aldrich). Fluorescence was measured with excitation and emission filters of 355 and 460 nm, respectively, on a Victor X3 multi-label plate reader (Perkin Elmer, Waltham, MA).
  • Cytotoxicity of uninfected parallel cultures was determined by addition of 100 ⁇ ⁇ of CellTitcr-Glo®reagcnt (Promega, Madison, WI), and incubation for 10 min at RT. Luminescence was measured on a Victor X3 multi-label plate reader.
  • EN PA FRET inhibition assay was performed using a 19 nucleotide synthetic oligoribonucleotide substrate: 5'-FAM-AUUUUGUUUUUAAUAUUUC-BHQ-3' (Integrated DNA Technologies, Inc., Coralville, LA) (SEQ. ID. NO.1). Upon RNA cleavage, the fluorescent FAM group is released from the BHQ quencher.
  • the PA sequence used to produce active enzyme is derived from any one of multiple influenza A virus strains (e.g., A/goosc/Nanchang/3- 120/01 (H3N2), A/Victoria/3/1975 (H3N2). A/Brisbane/ 10/2007 (H3N2).
  • A/WSN/33 (H1N1), A/CA/4/2009 (H1N1), A/CA/5/2009 (H1N1).
  • A/Shanghai/1/2013 (H7N9), A/Guizhou/1/2009 (H5N1)).
  • the full length recombinant protein was expressed from a baculovirus vector in insect cells.
  • Full length EN PA was used in this assay at an effective concentration of 1 to 10 Nm, together with 50 Nm FRET probe with a final volume of 20 ml cleavage buffer (20 Mm Tris Ph8, 100 Mm NaCl, 5% Glycerol. 10 Mm ⁇ - ⁇ , 0.01% Tween-20, 2 Mm MnCl 2 ).
  • IC50 is defined as the concentration at which fluorescence is 50% that of the uninhibited control (DMSO).
  • DMSO uninhibited control
  • the IC 50 values were derived from the mean of a minimum of two independent experiments.
  • Compounds of Formula (I) are potent in the assay as noted in Table 3, where ⁇ " indicates an lCso 250 Nm, " ⁇ ' indicates an lC 50 of >250 Nm and ⁇ 1000 Nm and 'C indicates an 1C 50 > 1000 Nm.
  • Viruses The influenza virus strains B/Malaysia/2506/2004 and B/Victoria/504/2000 were purchased from Virapur (San Diego. CA). The viruses had been previously titrated on MDCK cells at Virapur using the TCID 0 method.
  • A549 cells in assay media (Ham's F12 media supplemented with 0.3% FBS, 1 % penicillin/streptomycin, 1% HEPES. 1 % nonessential amino acids and 1 % Glutamine) were plated at a density of l x 10 ? cells/ml ( 1 x 10 4 cells/well) in white 96-well plates.
  • serially diluted compounds were added to cells.
  • Cells were infected with 500 IU/well of influenza strains B/Malaysia/2506/2004 or B/Victoria/504/2000 and incubated for 20 h at 37°C, 5% C0 2 .
  • the cell culture supernatant was aspirated off and 50 ⁇ of 25 ⁇ 2'-(4-Methylumbelliferyl)-a-D- N-acetylneuraminic acid (Sigma-Aldrich) dissolved in 33 mM MRS, pH 6.5 (Emerald Biosystems. Bainbridge Island. WA) was added to the cells. After incubation for 45 minutes at 37°C. reactions were stopped by the addition of 150 ⁇ stop solution (100 mM glycine, pH 10.5, 25% ethanol, all Sigma-Aldrich). Fluorescence was measured with excitation and emission filters of 355 and 460 nm, respectively, on a Victor X3 multi-label plate reader (Perkin Elmer. Waltham, MA).
  • Cell Viability Assay Promega's CellTiter-Glo Luminescent Cell Viability Assay (Cat. #G7572) was used to measure cell viability. Assay plates were set up as described above and CellTiter-Glo reagent ( 100 ⁇ ⁇ ) was added to each well and incubated at room temperature for 10 minutes. Luminescence was recorded using a Perkin Elmer multilabel counter Victor3V. The CC 50 , the concentration of the drug required to reduce the number of viable cells by 50% in relation to the untreated cell control value, was calculated from the plot of percentage reductions of the luminescence value against the drug concentrations using the Microsoft Excel forecast function. All compound tested had CC 50 values > 1 ⁇ .
  • dog kidney epithelial MDCK cells ATCC. Manassas, VA
  • maintenance media DMEM media supplemented w ith 10% FBS, 1 % penicillin/streptomycin. 1 % non-essential amino acids. 1 % Glutamine and 1 % HEPES (all Mediatech. Manassas. VA) at a density of 15 x 10 4 cells/ml (15 x 10 3 cells/well) in white 96-well plates with clear bottoms.
  • maintenance media was removed from cells.
  • Compounds were serially diluted in assay media (MEM media without phenol-red, supplemented with 0.3% FBS.
  • the volumes of synergy (positive volumes) or antagonism (negative volumes) represent the relative quantity of synergism or antagonism per change in the concentrations of the two drugs.
  • Synergy and antagonism volumes are defined based on the Bliss independence model. In this model, synergy volumes of less than -25 indicate antagonistic interactions, volumes in the -25 - 25 range indicate additive behavior, volumes in the 25 - 100 range indicate synergistic behavior and volumes > 100 indicate strong synergistic behavior. Determination of in vitro additive, synergistic and strongly synergistic behavior for combinations of compounds can be of utility in predicting therapeutic benefits for administering the combinations of compounds in vivo to infected patients.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Virology (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Emergency Medicine (AREA)
  • Communicable Diseases (AREA)
  • Oncology (AREA)
  • Zoology (AREA)
  • Gastroenterology & Hepatology (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
  • Pulmonology (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Nitrogen Condensed Heterocyclic Rings (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)
  • Acyclic And Carbocyclic Compounds In Medicinal Compositions (AREA)
  • Measuring Or Testing Involving Enzymes Or Micro-Organisms (AREA)

Abstract

Disclosed herein are aza-pyridone compounds, pharmaceutical compositions that include one or more aza-pyridone compounds, and methods of synthesizing the same. Also disclosed herein are methods of ameliorating and/or treating a disease and/or a condition, including an orthomyxovirus infection, with an aza-pyridone compounds. Examples of an orthomyxovirus viral infection include an influenza infection.

Description

AZA-PYRIDONE COMPOUNDS AND USES THEREOF
INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE TO ANY PRIORITY APPLICATIONS
[0001] Any and all applications for which a foreign or domestic priority claim is identified, for example, in the Application Data Sheet or Request as filed with the present application, are hereby incorporated by reference under 37 CFR 1.57, and Rules 4.18 and 20.6.
SEQUENCE LISTING
[0002] The present application is being filed along with a Sequence Listing in electronic format. The Sequence Listing is provided as a file entitled ALIOS078, created September 9, 2014. which is 4 kb bytes in size. The information in the electronic format of the Sequence Listing is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
BACKGROUND
Field
[0003] The present application relates to the fields of chemistry, biochemistry and medicine. More particularly, disclosed herein are aza-pyridone compounds, pharmaceutical compositions that include one or more aza-pyridone compounds, and methods of synthesizing the same. Also disclosed herein are methods of ameliorating and/or treating an orthomyxovirus viral infection with one or more aza-pyridone compounds.
Description
[0004] The viruses of the Orthomyxoviridae family are negative-sense, single- stranded RNA viruses. The Orthomyxoviridae family contains several genera including Influenzavirus A, Influenzavirus B, Influenzavirus C. Isavirus and Thogotovirus. Influenzaviruses can cause respiratory viral infections, including upper and lower respiratory tract viral infections. Respiratory viral infections are a leading cause of death of millions of people each year. Upper respiratory tract viral infections involve the nose, sinuses, pharynx and/or larynx. Lower respiratory tract viral infections involve the respiratory system below the vocal cords, including the trachea, primary7 bronchi and lungs. SUMMARY
[0005] Some embodiments disclosed herein relate to a compound of Formula (T), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
[0006] Some embodiments disclosed herein relate to methods of ameliorating and/or treating an orthomyxovirus viral infection that can include administering to a subject suffering from the orthomyxovirus viral infection an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. Other embodiments described herein relate to using one or more compounds of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in the manufacture of a medicament for ameliorating and/or treating an orthomyxovirus viral infection. Still other embodiments described herein relate to a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, that can be used for ameliorating and/or treating an orthomyxovirus viral infection. Yet still other embodiments disclosed herein relate to methods of ameliorating and/or treating an orthomyxovirus viral infection that can include contacting a cell infected with the orthomyxovirus with an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. Some embodiments disclosed herein relate to methods of preventing an orthomyxovirus infection that can include administering to a subject an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. For example, the orthomyxovirus viral infection can be an influenza viral infection (such as influenza A. B and/or C).
[0007] Some embodiments disclosed herein relate to methods of inhibiting the replication of an orthomyxovirus that can include contacting a cell infected with the orthomyxovirus with an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. For
-1- example, the orthomyxovirus viral infection can be an influenza viral infection (such as influenza A, B and/or C). Other embodiments disclosed herein relate to a method for inhibiting endonuclease activity of an influenza endonuclease that can include contacting the active site of the endonuclease with an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. These and other embodiments are described in greater detail below.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
[0008] Figure 1 shows example anti-influenza agents.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION
[0009] Influenza is a negative sense, single stranded RNA virus and a member of the Orthomyxoviridae family. There are currently three species of influenza; influenza A, influenza B and influenza C. Influenza A has a lipid membrane derived from the host cell, which contains the hemagglutinin, neuramididase and M2 proteins that project from the surface of the virus. Influenza A has been further classified based the hemagglutinin (I I or HA) and the neuramididase (N). There are approximately 16 H antigens (HI to HI 6) and 9 N antigens (Nl to N9). Influenza A includes several subtypes, including H1N1. H1N2. H2N2. H3N1. H3N2. H3N8, H5N1 , H5N2, H5N3. H5N8, H5N9, H7N1. H7N2, H7N3. H7N4. H7N7, H7N9, H9N2 and H10N7. The influenza virus polymerase is a heterotrimer composed of three subunits. polymerase acid (PA), polymerase basic 1 (PB 1 ) and polymerase basic 2 (PB2). This polymerase is responsible for replication and transcription of the viral RNA in the nuclei of infected cells. The PA subunit contains the endonuclease active site. The endonuclease activity of the PA cleaves the cellular mRNA. which is then used by the PB 1 subunit as a primer for the viral mRNA synthesis.
[0010] Influenza viruses can be transmitted from person to person via direct contact with infected secretions and/or contaminated surfaces or objections. Complications from an influenza viral infection include pneumonia, bronchitis, dehydration, and sinus and ear infections. Medications currently approved by the FDA against an influenza infection include a limited number of neuraminidase inhibitors and M2 protein inhibitors. Examples of approved neuraminidase inhibitors and 2 protein inhibitors include amantadine, rimantadine, Relenza® (zanamivir. GlaxoSmithKline) and Tamiflu® (oseltamivir. Genentech).
Definitions
[0011 ] Unless defined otherwise, all technical and scientific terms used herein have the same meaning as is commonly understood by one of ordinary skill in the art. AH patents, applications, published applications and other publications referenced herein are incorporated by reference in their entirety unless stated otherwise. In the event that there are a plurality of definitions for a term herein, those in this section prevail unless stated otherwise.
[00121 As used herein, any "R" group(s) such as, without limitation, R1 , R2, R"ia, R b, R4, R^ and Rb represent substituents that can be attached to the indicated atom. An R group may be substituted or unsubstituted. If two "R" groups are described as being "taken together" the R groups and the atoms they are attached to can form a cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl or heterocycle. For example, without limitation, if Rd and Rb of an NRd Rb group are indicated to be "taken together," it means that they are covalently bonded to one another to form a ring:
Figure imgf000006_0001
In addition, if two "R" groups are described as being "taken together" with the atom(s) to which they are attached to form a ring as an alternative, the R groups may not be limited to the variables or substituents defined previously.
[0013] Whenever a group is described as being "optionally substituted" that group may be unsubstituted or substituted with one or more of the indicated substituents. Likew ise, when a group is described as being "unsubstituted or substituted" if substituted, the substituent(s) may be selected from one or more of the indicated substituents. If no substituents are indicated, it is meant that the indicated "optionally substituted"' or "substituted" group may be substituted with one or more group(s) individually' and independently selected from alkyl, alkenyl, alkyny , cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl. heteroaryl. heterocyclyl. aryl(alkyl),
Figure imgf000007_0001
heterocyclyl(alkyl), hydroxy, alkoxy, acyl, cyano, halogen, thiocarbonyl, O-carbamyl, N-carbamyl, O-thiocarbamyl, N-thiocarbamyl, C-amido, N-amido. S-sulfonamido. N-sulfonamido, C-carboxy, O-carboxy, isocyanato. thiocyanato. isothiocyanato, azido, nitro. silyl, sulfenyl, sulfinyl. sulfonyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy. trihalomethanesulfonyl, trihalomethanesulfonamido, an amino, a mono-substituted amino group and a di -substituted amino group.
[0014] As used herein, "Ca to CV' in which "a" and "b" are integers refer to the number of carbon atoms in an alkyl, alkenyl or alkynyl group, or the number of carbon atoms in the ring of a cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaiyl or heterocyclyl group. That is, the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, ring(s) of the cycloalkyl, ring(s) of the cycloalkenyl, ring(s) of the aryl, ring(s) of the heteroary! or ring(s) of the heterocyclyl can contain from "a" to "b", inclusive, carbon atoms. Thus, for example, a "C i to C4 alkyl" group refers to all alkyl groups having from 1 to 4 carbons, that is, CH -, CH CH2-, CH3CH2CH2-, (CH3)2CH-, CH3CH2CH2CH2-, CH3CH2CH(CH3)- and (CH3)3C-. If no "a" and "b" are designated with regard to an alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl or heterocyclyl group, the broadest range described in these definitions is to be assumed.
[0015] As used herein, ''alkyl" refers to a straight or branched hydrocarbon chain that comprises a fully saturated (no double or triple bonds) hydrocarbon group. The alkyl group may have 1 to 20 carbon atoms (whenever it appears herein, a numerical range such as ;'l to 20" refers to each integer in the given range; e.g. , "\ to 20 carbon atoms" means that the alkyl group may consist of 1 carbon atom, 2 carbon atoms, 3 carbon atoms, etc. , up to and including 20 carbon atoms, although the present definition also covers the occurrence of the term "alkyl" where no numerical range is designated). The alkyl group may also be a medium size alkyl having 1 to 10 carbon atoms. The alkyl group could also be a lower alkyl having 1 to 6 carbon atoms. The alkyl group of the compounds may be designated as "C 1 -C4 alkyl" or similar designations. By way of example only, "C 1 -C4 alkyl" indicates that there are one to four carbon atoms in the alkyl chain, i.e., the alkyl chain is selected from methyl, ethyl, propyl, iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, sec-butyl, and t-butyl. Typical alkyl groups include, but are in no way limited to, methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, butyl, isobutyl, tertiary butyl, pentyl (straight and branched) and hexyl (straight and branched). The alkyl group may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0016] As used herein, "alkeny l" refers to an alkyl group that contains in the straight or branched hydrocarbon chain one or more double bonds. Examples of alkenyl groups include allenyl. vinylmethyl and ethenyl. An alkenyl group may be unsubstituted or substituted.
[0017] As used herein, "alkyny " refers to an alkyl group that contains in the straight or branched hydrocarbon chain one or more triple bonds. Examples of alkynyls include ethynyl and propynyl. An alkynyl group may be unsubstituted or substituted.
[0018] As used herein, "cycloalkyl" refers to a completely saturated (no double or triple bonds) mono- or multi-cyclic hydrocarbon ring system. When composed of two or more rings, the rings may be joined together in a fused fashion. Cycloalkyl groups can contain 3 to 10 atoms in the ring(s) or 3 to 8 atoms in the ring(s). A cycloalkyl group may be unsubstituted or substituted. Typical cycloalkyl groups include, but are in no way limited to, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl and cyclooctyl.
[0019] As used herein, "cycloalkenyp refers to a mono- or multi-cyclic hydrocarbon ring system that contains one or more double bonds in at least one ring; although, if there is more than one, the double bonds cannot form a fully delocahzed pi- electron system throughout all the rings (otherwise the group would be "aryl,"' as defined herein). When composed of two or more rings, the rings may be connected together in a fused fashion. A cycloalkenyl can contain 3 to 10 atoms in the ring(s) or 3 to 8 atoms in the ring(s). A cycloalkenyl group may be unsubstituted or substituted.
[0020] As used herein, "aryl" refers to a carbocyclic (all carbon) mono-cyclic or multi-cyclic aromatic ring system (including fused ring systems where two carbocyclic rings share a chemical bond) that has a fully delocalized pi-electron system throughout all the rings. The number of carbon atoms in an aryl group can vary. For example, the aryl group can be a C C 14 aryl group, a C6-C |0 aryl group, or a C6 aryl group. Examples of aryl groups include, but are not limited to, benzene, naphthalene and azulene. An aryl group may be substituted or unsubstituted. [0021] As used herein, "heteroaryl" refers to a mono-cyclic or multi-cyclic aromatic ring system (a ring system with fully delocalized pi-electron system) that contain(s) one or more heteroatoms (for example, 1 to 5 heteroatoms), that is, an element other than carbon, including but not limited to. nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur. The number of atoms in the ring(s) of a heteroaryl group can vary. For example, the heteroaryl group can contain 4 to 14 atoms in the ring(s). 5 to 10 atoms in the ring(s) or 5 to 6 atoms in the ring(s). Furthermore, the term "heteroaryl" includes fused ring systems where two rings, such as at least one aryl ring and at least one heteroaryl ring, or at least two heteroaryl rings, share at least one chemical bond. Examples of heteroaryl rings include, but are not limited to, furan, furazan, thiophene, benzothiophene, phthalazine, pyrrole, oxazole, benzoxazole, 1 ,2,3-oxadiazole, 1 ,2.4-oxadiazole, thiazole, 1 ,2,3 -thiadiazole, 1 ,2,4-thiadiazole, benzothiazole, imidazole, benzimidazole, indole, indazole, pyrazole, benzopyrazole, isoxazole. benzoisoxazole, isothiazole, triazole, benzotriazole, thiadiazole, tetrazole, pyridine, pyridazine. pynmidine, pyrazine, purine, pteridine, quinoline, isoquinoline, quinazoline. quinoxaline, cinnoline and triazine. A heteroary l group may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0022] As used herein, "heterocyclyl" or "heteroalicyclyl" refers to three-, four-, five-, six-, seven-, eight-, nine-, ten-, up to 1 8-membered mono-cyclic, bicyclic, and tricyclic ring system wherein carbon atoms together with from 1 to 5 heteroatoms constitute said ring system. A heterocycle may optionally contain one or more unsaturated bonds situated in such a way, however, that a fully delocalized pi-electron system does not occur throughout all the rings. The heteroatom(s) is an element other than carbon including, but not limited to. oxygen, sulfur, and nitrogen. A heterocycle may further contain one or more carbonyl or thiocarbonyl functionalities, so as to make the definition include oxo-systems and thio- systems such as lactams, lactones, cyclic imides, cyclic thioimides and cyclic carbamates. When composed of two or more rings, the rings may be joined together in a fused fashion. Additionally, any nitrogens in a heterocyclyl or a heteroalicyclyl may be quaternized. Heterocyclyl or heteroalicyclic groups may be unsubstituted or substituted. Examples of such "heterocyclyl" or "heteroalicyclyi'" groups include but are not limited to. 1 ,3-dioxin, 1 ,3- dioxane, 1 ,4-dioxane, 1 ,2-dioxolane, 1.3-dioxolane, 1 ,4-dioxolane, 1 ,3-oxathiane, 1 ,4- oxathiin, 1 ,3-oxathiolane, 1 ,3-dithiole, 1 ,3-dithiolane, 1 ,4-oxathiane, tetrahydro- 1 ,4-thiazine, 2H- l ,2-oxazine, maleimide, succinimide, barbituric acid, thiobarbituric acid, dioxopipcrazine, hydantoin, dihydrouracil, trioxanc, hexahydro-l ,3,5-triazine, imidazoline, imidazolidine, isoxazoline, isoxazolidine, oxazoline, oxazolidine, oxazolidinone, thiazoline. thiazolidine, morpholine, oxirane, piperidine Λ-Oxide. piperidine. piperazine, pyrrolidine, pyrrolidone, pyrrolidione, 4-piperidone, pyrazolone, pyrazolidine, 2-oxopyrrolidine. tetrahydropyran, 4H-pyran, tetrahydrothiopyran, thiamorpholine, thiamorpholine sulfoxide, thiamorpholine sulfone. and their benzo-fused analogs (e.g., benzimidazolidinone. tetrahyd roqui no 1 in e and 3.4 -met by 1 en ed i oxypheny 1 ) .
[0023] As used herein, "aralkyl" and "aryl(alkyl)" refer to an aryl group connected, as a substituent, via a lower alkylene group. The lower alkylene and/or aryl group of an aryi(alkyl) may be substituted or unsubstituted. Examples include but are not limited to benzyl, 2-phenyi(alkyi), 3-phenyl(alkyl), and naphthyl(alkyl).
[0024] As used herein, "heteiOaralkyf and "heteiOaryl(alkyl)" refer to a heteroaryl group connected, as a substituent, via a lower alkylene group. The lower alkylene and/or heteroaryl group of heteroaryl(alkyl) may be substituted or unsubstituted. Examples include but are not limited to 2-thienyl(alkyl), 3-thienyl(alkyT). furyl(alkyl), thienyl(alkyl), pyrrolyl(alkyl), pyridyl(alkyl), isoxazolyl(alkyl), imidazolyl(alkyl), and their benzo-fused analogs.
[0025] A "heteroalicyclyl(alkyl)" and "heterocyclyKalkyl)" refer to a heterocyclic or a heteroalicyclylic group connected, as a substituent. via a lower alkylene group. The lower alkylene and/or heterocyclyl of a heterocyclyl(alkyl) may be substituted or unsubstituted. Examples include but are not limited tetrahydro-2H-pyran-4-yl(methyl), piperidin-4-yl(ethyl). piperidin-4-yl(piOpyl), tetrahydro-2H-thiopyran-4-yl(methy ), and l ,3-thiazinan-4-yl(methyl).
[0026] "Lower alkylene groups" are straight-chained -CH2- tethering groups, forming bonds to connect molecular fragments via their terminal carbon atoms. Examples include but are not limited to methylene (-CH2-), ethylene (-CH2CH2-), propylene (- CH2CH2CH2-), and butylene (-CH2CH2CH2CIT2-). A lower alkylene group can be substituted by replacing one or more hydrogen of the low¾r alkylene group with a substituent(s) listed under the definition of "substituted." [0027] As used herein, "alkoxy" refers to the formula -OR wherein R is alky], alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, cycloalkyl(alkyl), aryl(alkyl). heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl) is defined herein. A non-limiting list of alkoxys are methoxy. ethoxy, n-propoxy, 1 -methylethoxy (isopropoxy), n-butoxy. iso-butoxy. sec-butoxy, tert-butoxy. phenoxy and benzoxy. An alkoxy may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0028] As used herein, "acyl" refers to a hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, or aryl connected, as substituents, via a carbonyl group. Examples include formyl, acetyl, propanoyl. benzoyl and acryl. An acyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0029] As used herein, "haloalkyl" refers to an alkyl group in which one or more of the hydrogen atoms are replaced by a halogen (e.g., mono-haloalkyl, di-haloalkyl and tri- haloalkyl). Such groups include but are not limited to, chloromethyl, iluoromethyl, dilluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl, l -chloiO-2-fluoromethyl and 2-fluoroisobutyl. A haloalkyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0030] As used herein, "haloalkoxy" refers to an alkoxy group of the formula -O- alkyi in which one or more of the hydrogen atoms are replaced by a halogen (e.g., mono- haloalkoxy, di- haloalkoxy and tri- haloalkoxy ). Such groups include but are not limited to, chloromethoxy, fluoromcthoxy, difluoromethoxy, trifluoromethoxy. l -chloro-2- fluoromethoxy and 2-fluoroisobutoxy. A haloalkoxy may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0031 ] A "sulfenyr group refers to an "-SR" group in which R can be hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl. aryl. heteroaryl. heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl). heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl). A sulfenyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0032] A "sulfinyl" group refers to an "-S(=0)-R" group in which R can be the same as defined with respect to sulfenyl. A sulfinyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0033] A "sulfonyl" group refers to an "SC R" group in w hich R can be the same as defined with respect to sulfenyl. A sulfonyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0034] An 'O-carboxy" group refers to a "RC(=0)0-" group in which R can be hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyi). heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyi( alkyl), as defined herein. An O-carboxy may be substituted or unsubstituted. [0035] The terms "ester'' and "C-carboxy" refer to a "-C(=0)OR" group in which R can be the same as defined with respect to O-carboxy. An ester and C-carboxy may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0036] A "thiocarbonyp group refers to a "-C(=S)R" group in which R can be the same as defined with respect to O-carboxy. A thiocarbonyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0037] A "trihalomethanesulfonyl" group refers to an "X3CS02-" group wherein each X is a halogen.
[0038] A "trihalomethanesulfonamido" group refers to an "X3CS(0)2N(RA)-*" group wdierein each X is a halogen, and A is hydrogen, alkyl. alkenyl. alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl) .
[0039] The term "amino" as used herein refers to a -NH2 group.
[0040] As used herein, the term "hydroxy"'' refers to a -OH group.
[0041] A "cyano" group refers to a "-CN"* group.
[0042] The term "azido"' as used herein refers to a -N group.
[0043] An "isocyanato" group refers to a "- CO" group.
[0044] A "thiocyanato" group refers to a "-CNS" group.
[0045] An "isothiocyanato"' group refers to an " -NCS" group.
[0046] A "carbonyf* group refers to a C=0 group.
[0047] An "S-sulfonamido" group refers to a "-S02N(RARB)" group in which RA and RR can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl. aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl). An S-sulfonamido may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0048] An "N-sulfonamido" group refers to a "RS02N(RA)-" group in which R and RA can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkeny l, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl. aryl(alky ), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocycly (alkyl). An N-sulfonamido may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0049] An "O-carbamyl" group refers to a "-OC(=0)N(RARB)" group in which R4 and RB can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl). An O-carbamyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0050] An "N-carbamyl" group refers to an "ROC(=0)N(RA)-" group in which R and RA can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkeny l, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl). An N-carbamyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0051 ] An "O-thiocarbamyl" group refers to a "-OC(=S)-N(RARB)" group in which RA and RB can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl. alkynyl, cycloalkyl. cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl. heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl). heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl). An O-thiocarbamyl may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0052] An "N-thiocarbamyl" group refers to an
Figure imgf000013_0001
group in which R and RA can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl). An N-thiocarbamy! may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0053] A "C-amido" group refers to a "-C(=0)N(RARB)" group in which RA and R can be independently hydrogen, alkyl. alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl), heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl). A C-amido may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0054] An "N-amido" group refers to a "RC(=0)N(RA)-" group in which R and RA can be independently hydrogen, alkyl, alkeny l, alkynyl. cycloalkyl, cycloalkeny l, aryl. heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, aryl(alkyl). heteroaryl(alkyl) or heterocyclyl(alkyl). An N-amido may be substituted or unsubstituted.
[0055] The term "halogen atom" or "halogen" as used herein, means any one of the radio-stable atoms of column 7 of the Periodic Table of the Elements, such as, fluorine, chlorine, bromine and iodine.
[0056] Where the numbers of substituents is not specified (e.g. haloalkyl), there may be one or more substituents present. For example "haloalkyl" may include one or more of the same or different halogens. As another example, "C | -Cj alkoxyphenyl" may include one or more of the same or different alkoxy groups containing one, two or three atoms. [0057] As used herein, the abbreviations for any protective groups, amino acids and other compounds, are, unless indicated otherwise, in accord with their common usage, recognized abbreviations, or the IUPAC-IUB Commission on Biochemical Nomenclature (See, Biochem. 1 1 :942-944 ( 1972)).
[0058] The terms "protecting group" and "protecting groups" as used herein refer to any atom or group of atoms that is added to a molecule in order to prevent existing groups in the molecule from undergoing unwanted chemical reactions. Examples of protecting group moieties are described in T. W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, 3. Ed. John Wiley & Sons. 1999, and in J.F.W. McOmie, Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry Plenum Press, 1973, both of which are hereby incorporated by reference for the limited purpose of disclosing suitable protecting groups. The protecting group moiety may be chosen in such a way, that they are stable to certain reaction conditions and readily removed at a convenient stage using methodology known from the art. A non-limiting list of protecting groups include benzyl; substituted benzyl; alkylcarbonyls and alkoxycarbonyls (e.g., t-butoxycarbonyl (BOC), acetyl and isobutyryl); arylalkylcarbonyls and arylalkoxycarbonyls (e.g., benzyloxycarbonyl); substituted methyl ether (e.g. methoxymethyl ether and tetrahydropyranyl ether); substituted ethyl ether; a substituted benzyl ether; silyls (e.g.. trimethylsilyl, triethylsilyl. triisopropylsilyl. t-butyldimethylsilyl. txx-iso- propylsilyloxymethyl, [2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxy]rnethyl and t-butyldiphenylsilyl); esters (e.g. benzoate ester); carbonates (e.g. methoxymethylcarbonate); sulfonates (e.g. tosylate and mesylate); acyclic ketal (e.g. dimethyl acetal and diisopropyl acetal); cyclic ketals (e.g., 1 ,3- dioxane and 1 ,3-dioxolane); acyclic acetal; cyclic acetal; acyclic hemiacetal; cyclic hemiacetal; dithioacetals (both cyclic and acyclic); dithioketals (both cyclic and acyclic) (e.g.. S^-dimethyl, S.S"-diethyl. S.S"-diispropyl, 1 ,3-dithiane and 1 ,3-dithiolane); orthoesters (including cyclic orthoesters. such as cyclic orthoformates); carbamates (e.g., N- phenylcarbamate) and triary!methyl groups (e.g., trityl, monomethoxytrityl (MMTr). 4,4'- dimethoxytrityi (DMTr). and 4,4',4"-trimethoxytrityl (TMTr); and those described herein).
[0059] "Leaving group*" as used herein refers to any atom or moiety that is capable of being displaced by another atom or moiety in a chemical reaction. More specifically, in some embodiments, "leaving group" refers to the atom or moiety that is displaced in a nucleophilic substitution reaction. In some embodiments, "leaving groups*' are any atoms or moieties that are conjugate bases of strong acids. Examples of suitable leaving groups include, but are not limited to. tosylates, mesylates, trifluoroacetates and halogens (e.g.. I, Br, and CI). Non-limiting characteristics and examples of leaving groups can be found, for example in Organic Chemistry, 2d ed.. Francis Carey ( 1992), pages 328-331 ; Introduction to Organic Chemistry, 2d ed., Andrew Streitwieser and Clayton Heathcock (1981 ). pages 169-1 71 ; and Organic Chemistry, 5th ed.. John McMurry (2000), pages 398 and 408; all of which are incorporated herein by reference for the limited purpose of disclosing characteristics and examples of leaving groups.
[0060] The term "pharmaceutically acceptable salt" refers to a salt of a compound that does not cause significant irritation to an organism to which it is administered and does not abrogate the biological activity and properties of the compound. In some embodiments, the salt is an acid addition salt of the compound. Pharmaceutical salts can be obtained by reacting a compound with inorganic acids such as hydrohalic acid (e.g., hydrochloric acid or hydrobromic acid), sulfuric acid, nitric acid and phosphoric acid. Pharmaceutical salts can also be obtained by reacting a compound with an organic acid such as aliphatic or aromatic carboxylic or sulfonic acids, for example formic, acetic, succinic, lactic, malic, tartaric, citric, ascorbic, nicotinic, methanesulfonic, ethanesulfonic. p-toluensulfonic. salicylic or naphthalenesulfonic acid. Pharmaceutical salts can also be obtained by reacting a compound with a base to form a salt such as an ammonium salt, an alkali metal salt, such as a sodium or a potassium salt, an alkaline earth metal salt, such as a calcium or a magnesium salt, a salt of organic bases such as dicyclohexylamine, N-methyl-D-glucamine. tris(hydroxymethyl)methylamine, C]-Cy alkylamine. cyclohexylamine. triethanolamine. ethyienediamine, and salts with amino acids such as arginine and lysine.
[00611 Terms and phrases used in this application, and variations thereof, especially in the appended claims, unless otherwise expressly stated, should be construed as open ended as opposed to limiting. As examples of the foregoing, the term 'including' should be read to mean 'including, without limitation,' 'including but not limited to,' or the like; the term 'comprising' as used herein is synonymous with 'including,' 'containing,' or 'characterized by," and is inclusive or open-ended and does not exclude additional, unrecited elements or method steps; the term 'having' should he interpreted as 'having at least;" the term 'includes" should be interpreted as 'includes but is not limited to;" the term 'example" is used to provide exemplary instances of the item in discussion, not an exhaustive or limiting list thereof; and use of terms like 'preferably.' 'preferred," 'desired.' or 'desirable,' and words of similar meaning should not be understood as implying that certain features are critical, essential, or even important to the structure or function, but instead as merely intended to highlight alternative or additional features that may or may not be utilized in a particular embodiment. In addition, the term "comprising" is to be interpreted synonymously with the phrases "having at least" or "including at least". When used in the context of a process, the term "comprising" means that the process includes at least the recited steps, but may include additional steps. When used in the context of a compound, composition or device, the term "comprising" means that the compound, composition or device includes at least the recited features or components, but may also include additional features or components. Likewise, a group of items linked with the conjunction 'and' should not be read as requiring that each and every one of those items be present in the grouping, but rather should be read as 'and/or' unless expressly stated otherwise. Similarly, a group of items linked with the conjunction 'or' should not be read as requiring mutual exclusivity among that group, but rather should be read as 'and/or" unless expressly stated otherwise.
[0062] With respect to the use of substantially any plural and/or singular terms herein, those having skill in the art can translate from the plural to the singular and/or from the singular to the plural as is appropriate to the context and/or application. The various singular/plural permutations may be expressly set forth herein for sake of clarity. The indefinite article "a" or "an"' does not exclude a plurality. A single processor or other unit may fulfill the functions of several items recited in the claims. The mere fact that certain measures are recited in mutually different dependent claims does not indicate that a combination of these measures cannot be used to advantage. Any reference signs in the claims should not be construed as limiting the scope.
[0063] It is understood that, in any compound described herein having one or more chiral centers, if an absolute stereochemistry is not expressly indicated, then each center may independently be of R-configiiration or S-configuration or a mixture thereof. Thus, the compounds provided herein may be enantiomerically pure, enantiomerically enriched, raccmic mixture, diastereomcrically pure, diastereomcrically enriched, or a stereoisomeric mixture. In addition it is understood that, in any compound described herein having one or more double bond(s) generating geometrical isomers that can be defined as E or Z. each double bond may independently be E or Z a mixture thereof.
[0064] It is to be understood that where compounds disclosed herein have unfilled valencies, then the valencies are to be filled with hydrogens or isotopes thereof, e.g.. hydrogen- 1 (protium) and hydrogen-2 (deuterium).
[0065] It is understood that the compounds described herein can be labeled isotopically. Substitution with isotopes such as deuterium may afford certain therapeutic advantages resulting from greater metabolic stability, such as, for example, increased in vivo half-life or reduced dosage requirements. Each chemical element as represented in a compound structure may include any isotope of said element. For example, in a compound structure a hydrogen atom may be explicitly disclosed or understood to be present in the compound. At any position of the compound that a hydrogen atom may be present, the hydrogen atom can be any isotope of hydrogen, including but not limited to hydrogen- 1 (protium) and hydrogen-2 (deuterium). Thus, reference herein to a compound encompasses all potential isotopic forms unless the context clearly dictates otherwise.
[0066] It is understood that the methods and combinations described herein include crystalline forms (also known as polymorphs, which include the different crystal packing arrangements of the same elemental composition of a compound), amorphous phases, salts, solvates, and hydrates. In some embodiments, the compounds described herein exist in solvated forms with pharmaceutically acceptable solvents such as water, ethanol. or the like. In other embodiments, the compounds described herein exist in unsolvated form. Solvates contain either stoichiometric or non-stoichiometric amounts of a solvent, and may be formed during the process of crystallization with pharmaceutically acceptable solvents such as water, ethanol, or the like. Hydrates are formed when the solvent is water, or alcoholates are formed when the solvent is alcohol. In addition, the compounds provided herein can exist in unsolvated as well as solvated forms. In general, the solvated forms are considered equivalent to the unsolvated forms for the purposes of the compounds and methods provided herein.
[0067] Where a range of values is provided, it is understood that the upper and lower limit, and each intervening value between the upper and lower limit of the range is encompassed within the embodiments.
Compounds
[0068] Some embodiments disclosed herein relate to a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically accept
Figure imgf000018_0001
wherein: can be a single bond or double bond; R can be selected from hydrogen, an unsubstituted C alkyl
Figure imgf000018_0002
-(CH2)-0-(C=0)-0- Y1, -(CHCH3)-0-(C=0)-Y' and -^ΗΟΗ3)-0-(χ 0)-0-Υ' ; R2 can be selected from hydrogen, an optionally substituted C|-6 alkyl, an optionally substituted heterocyclyl, an optionally substituted cycloalkyl(Ci-6 alkyl), an optionally substituted aryl(C|-6 alkyl), an optionally substituted heteroaiyl(Ci-6 alkyl) and an optionally substituted heterocyclyl(Ci-6 alkyl); RJA and RJH can be independently hydrogen or an optionally substituted C alkyl; R4 and R? can be independently selected from hydrogen, an optionally substituted aryl, an optionally substituted aryl(Ci-6 alkyl) an optionally substituted heteroaryl and an optionally substituted heteroaiyl(Ci.6 alkyl). provided that at least one of R4 and R3 is not hydrogen; or R4 and R5 can be taken together to form an optionally substituted tricyclic cycloalkenyl or an optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl; R6 can be selected from hydrogen, halogen, -CM, an optionally substituted Ci-6 alkyl, an optionally substituted aryl, an optionally substituted heteroaryl, -CH2OH, -CH(Y2)(OH) and -C(0)Y2; and Υ' and Y2 can be independently selected from an optionally substituted C|.& alkyl, an optionally substituted C3-6 cycloalkyl, an optionally substituted aryl an optionally substituted heteroaryl, an optionally substituted
7 S heterocyclyl. a mono-substitutcd amino group, a di-substituted amino and -C(R')NHR°; and
7 8
R' and R° can be independently hydrogen or an optionally substituted C alkyl.
[0069] Various groups can be present for R4 and R~\ In some embodiments, R4 can be hydrogen. In other embodiments. R4 can be an optionally substituted aryl, such as an optionally substituted pheny l or an optionally substituted naphthyl. When the pheny l ring is substituted, it can be substituted 1 , 2, or 3 or more times. When R4 is a mono-substituted phenyl, the mono-substituted phenyl can be ortho-substituted. meta-substituted or para- substituted. In still other embodiments, R4 can be an optionally substituted aryl(Ci-6 alkyl). For example, R4 can be an optionally substituted benzyl. The phenyl ring of the benzyl group can be unsubstituted or substituted 1 , 2, or 3 or more times. In yet still other embodiments, R4 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl. In some embodiments, R4 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl(C| -6 alkyl). Examples of optionally substituted heteroaryls include, but are not limited to. an optionally substituted imidazole (
Figure imgf000019_0001
) and an
Figure imgf000019_0002
optionally substituted pyrazole The heteroaryl ring of an optionally substituted heteroaryl and an optionally substituted heteroaryl(C i -6 alkyl) can be unsubstituted or substituted with 1 , 2 or 3 or more substituents.
[0070] In some embodiments, including those of the preceding paragraph, Rs can be an optionally substituted aryl. For example, R""1 can be an optionally substituted phenyl or an optionally substituted naphthyl. When R3 is a mono-substituted phenyl, the mono- substituted phenyl can be ortho-substituted, meta-substituted or para-substituted. In still other embodiments, R5 can be an optionally substituted aryl(C| -6 alkyl). such as an optionally substituted benzyl. The optionally substituted aryl and aryl ring of the an optionally substituted aryl(C|-6 alkyl) can be unsubstituted or substituted with 1 , 2 or 3 or more substituents. In still other embodiments. R4 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl. For example, R4 can be an optionally substituted pyridinyl. an optionally substituted imidazolyl or an optionally substitute pyrazolyl. In yet still other embodiments. R4 is an optionally substituted heteroaryl(Ci-6 alkyl). When substituted, the optionally substituted heteroaryl and the optionally substituted heteroaryl(C | _6 alkyl) can be substituted 1 , 2 or 3 or more times. In some embodiments, R4 and/or R? can be substituted with one or more substituents selected from halo (such as fluoro, chloro and iodo). C alkyl (for example, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl. iso-propyl. n-butyl. iso-butyl. tert-butyl). C2-4 alkynyl, a haloalkyl (such as CF3), hydroxy, Ci_ 4 alkoxy (for example, methoxy. ethoxy, n-propoxy. iso-propoxy, cyclopropoxy and
Figure imgf000020_0001
and an optionally substituted aryl (for example, an optionally substituted phenyl), cyano, NC-(CH2)-, H2N- =0)-(CH2)-, 0-amido(CH2)- and an optionally
substituted heteroaryl(C I _6 alky l) (such
Figure imgf000020_0002
)
[0071 ] In some embodiments, R4 and R~ can each be an optionally substituted phenyl. For example. R4 and R? can be each a substituted phenyl substituted with one or more group selected from halo (such as fluoro, chloro and iodo). C alkyl (for example, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl. iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, tert-butyl). C2-4 alkynyl. a haloalkyl (such as CF3), hyd (for example, methoxy. ethoxy. n-propoxy, iso-propoxy.
cyclopropoxy and
Figure imgf000020_0003
and an optionally substituted aryl (for example, an optionally substituted phenyl), cyano, NC(C alkyl) (for example, NC-(CH2)-), 0-amido(C | . 4 alkyl)- (for and an optionally substituted heteroaryl(C 1 -6
alkyl) (such
Figure imgf000020_0004
me embodiments. R4 and R? can each be a deuterated pheny l. The deuteratd phenyl can include one or more deuteriums (for example, 1 . 2. 3, 4 or 5 deuteriums). In some embodiments, R4 and R^ can be the same. For example. R4 and RD can both be an unsubstituted phenyl. In other embodiments. R4 and R3 can be different. As an example. R4 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl (such as an optionally substituted mono-cyclic heteroaryl), and R3 can be an optionally substituted aryl (such as an optionally substituted phenyl). As an another example, R4 can be an optionally substituted aryl (such as an optionally substituted phenyl), and R1 can be an optionally substituted aryl(C | -6 alkyl) (such as an optionally substituted benzyl). [0072] Instead of being separate groups, R4 and RJ can be taken together to form a tricyclic ring group. In some embodiments, R4 and R? can be taken together to form an optionally substituted tricyclic cycloalkenyl. In some embodiments. R4 and R? can be taken together to form an optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl. One. two or more than to heteroatoms can be present in the optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl such as nitrogen (N). oxygen (O) and sulfur (S). including oxidized versions of sulfur (e.g.. S=0 and S=02). The optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl can be two aryl rings and one heterocyclyl ring, wherein the aryl rings can be the same or different. Alternatively, the optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl can be two heteroaryl rings and one cycloalkenyl ring, wherein the heteroaryl rings can be the same or different; one aryl ring, one cycloalkenyl ring and one heterocyclyl ring; two heterocyclyl rings and one cycloalkenyl or cycloalkyl ring. When substituted, one or more of the rings of the optionally substituted tricyclic cycloalkenyl and/or the optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl can be substituted one or more times. Various groups can be substituted on an optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl. such as halogen (such as fliioro, chloro and iodo) and/or C alkyl (for example, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl. iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl and tert-butyl). Examples of the optionally substituted tricyclic cycloalkenyl and the optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl include, but are not limited to, the following optionally substituted moieties:
Figure imgf000021_0001
^ 2
[0073] In some embodiments, R" can be hydrogen. In other embodiments, R can be an optionally substituted Ci-6 alkyl. In some embodiments. R" can be an unsubstituted C j_ alkyl. The C i-6 alkyl can be methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl. n-butyl, iso-butyl, tert-butyl. pentyl (straight or branched) or hexyl (straight or branched). In some embodiments, R" can be a substituted C|-6 alkyl. Various substituents can substitute the C | -6 alkyl of R . In some embodiments, the substituted Ci-6 alkyl of R" can be substituted one or more times with a substituents selected from halogen, haloalkyl (such as CF3), hydroxy and alkoxy. When substituted, in some embodiments, the one or more substituents on R2 may not be present on the carbon closest to the nitrogen of the fused ring system. When R2 is substituted at the carbon attached to the carbon closest to the nitrogen of the fused ring sy stem of Formula (T). the carbon may be a chiral center. In some embodiments, the chiral center can be a (S)-chiral center. In other embodiments, the chiral center can be a (7?)-chiral center.
[0074] In some embodiments. R~ can be an optionally substituted cycloalkyl(Ci-6 alkyl). In other embodiments, " can be an optionally substituted heterocyclyl. In other embodiments, R" can be an optionally substituted aryl(C | -6 alkyl), such as an optionally substituted benzyl. The phenyl ring of the benzyl ring can be substituted 1 , 2 or 3 or more times. When the phenyl ring of the benzyl group is mono-substituted, the phenyl ring can be substituted at the ortho-, meta- or para-position. In still other embodiments, R2 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl(C 1 -6 alkyl). In yet still other embodiments, R2 can be an optionally substituted heterocyclyl(C i-6 alkyl). Examples of R2 groups include, but are not
limited to, hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, n- ro yl, iso ro y-l, n-butyl, isobutyl.
Figure imgf000022_0001
Figure imgf000022_0002
tetrahydro-2H- pyran and benzyl.
[0075] Various groups can be present at the R1 position. In some embodiments, R1 can be hydrogen. In other embodiments, R1 can be an unsubstituted C alkyl. For example, R1 can be methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, iso-propyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl and t-butyi. In still other embodiments. R1 can be a group that in vivo is capable of providing a compound of Formula (I), wherein R1 is hydrogen or absent. Those skilled in the art understand that when R1 is absent, the oxygen adjacent to R1 can possess as associated negative charge. Examples of R1 moieties that are capable of providing a compound of Formula (I), wherein R1 is hydrogen or absent, include -C(=0)Y' and -C(=0)-0-Y ' . Additional examples of R1 moieties that are capable of providing a compound of Formula (I), wherein R is hydrogen or absent, include
Figure imgf000023_0001
or -(CHCH )-0-(C=0)-0-Y' . In some embodiments, R can be a group that is enzymatically cleaved to provide a compound of Formula (1). w herein R1 is hydrogen or absent.
[0076] As described herein, Y1 can be a variety of substituents. In some embodiments, Y1 can be a substituted Ci-6 alkyl. In other embodiments, Y1 can be an unsubstituted C i-6 alkyl. In still other embodiments, Y1 can be a substituted C3.6 cycloalkyl. In yet still other embodiments. Y1 can be an unsubstituted C3-6 cycloalkyl. In some embodiments, Y1 can be a substituted aryl (for example, a substituted phenyl). In other embodiments, Y 1 can be an unsubstituted aryl (for example, an unsubstituted phenyl). In still other embodiments, Y 1 can be a substituted heteroaryl (such as a substituted mono-cyclic heteroaryl). In yet still other embodiments, Y 1 can be an unsubstituted heteroaryl (such as an unsubstituted heteroaryl). In some embodiments, Y1 can be a substituted heterocyclyl (such as a substituted mono-cyclic heterocyclyl). In other embodiments, Y1 can be an unsubstituted heterocyclyl (such as an unsubstituted heterocyclyl). In still other embodiments, Y 1 can be a mono-substituted amino group. For example, the mono-substituted amino group can be
Figure imgf000023_0002
rein Het can be an optionally substituted
Figure imgf000023_0003
[0077] Example groups for R include, but are not limited to, the following
Figure imgf000024_0001
[0078] Various substituents can be present on the fused rings of Formula (I). For example, in some embodiments, R6 can be hydrogen. In other embodiments, R6 can be halogen. In still other embodiments, R6 can be -CN . In yet still other embodiments, R6 can be an optionally substituted C | -6 alkyl. For example, R6 can be methyl, ethyl, propyl (straight or branched), butyl (straight or branched), pcntyl (straight or branched) or hcxyl (straight or branched). In some embodiments, R6 can be an optionally substituted aryl (such as a mono-, di- or 3 or more substituted phenyl). In other embodiments, R6 can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl. In still other embodiments. R6 can be -CH2OH. -CH(Y2)(OH) or - C(0)Y2. In some embodiments, a portion of R6 can be enzymatically cleaved to provide a compound of Formula (I), wherein OH or O" is present at R6.
[0079] In some embodiments, R',D and R3B can be independently hydrogen or an optionally substituted C alkyl. In some embodiments. R3A and RJB can be both hydrogen. In other embodiments, at least one of R~,A and R~L can be an optionally substituted C M alkyl. For example, one or both of R"'A and R3B can be an unsubstituted or substituted C M alkyl. In some embodiments, R3A and R'LB can be both an unsubstituted C alkyl, for example, both R A and R, B can be methyl. In some embodiments, R A and R1 1 can be the same. In other embodiments, R,D and R,B can be different. [0080] In some embodiments, can be a single bond such that a compound
of Formula (I) has the structure
Figure imgf000025_0001
When is a single bond, the bond indicated with an * can be a (LS)-chiral center or a ( ?)-chiral center as shown herein:
Figure imgf000025_0002
. In other embodiments, ------- can be a double bond such that a compound of Formula (I) has the structure
Figure imgf000025_0003
Figure imgf000026_0001
-24-
Figure imgf000027_0001
Figure imgf000028_0001
Figure imgf000029_0001
Figure imgf000030_0001
-28-
Figure imgf000031_0001
Figure imgf000032_0001
Figure imgf000033_0001
-31-
Figure imgf000034_0001
, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing.
ally examples of compounds of Formula (1) include the following:
Figure imgf000034_0002
Figure imgf000035_0001
of the foregoing.
-J J)- [0083] Examples of compounds of Formula (I) also include the following:
Figure imgf000036_0001
Figure imgf000037_0001
-35-
Figure imgf000038_0001
Figure imgf000038_0002
pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing.
[0085] As described herein, at any position of a compound of Formula (I) that has a hydrogen, the hydrogen can be an isotope of hydrogen, such as hydrogen-2 (deuterium). In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I) can be a compound of Formula (la). Some embodiments of a compound of Formula (la) are provided in Table A.
Figure imgf000039_0001
Table A
R3a R3b R6 R"1 Rm RJ No. deuteriums on R4 R5 No. deuteriums on R5
D D D D D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
H D D D D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D H D D D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D D H D D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D D D H D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D D D D H phenyl 0 phenyl 0
H H D D D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
H D H D D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
H D D H D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
H D D D H phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D H H D D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D H D H D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D H D D H phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D D n I I D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D D H D H phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D D D H H phenyl 0 phenyl 0
H H H D D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
H H D H D phenyl 0 pheny l 0
H H D D H phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D H H H D phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D H H D H phenyl 0 pheny l 0
D D H H H phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D H H H H phenyl 0 phenyl 0
H D H H H phenyl 0 pheny l 0
H H D H H phenyl 0 phenyl 0
H H H D H phenyl 0 phenyl 0
H H H H D phenyl 0 pheny l 0
H H H H H phenyl 0 phenyl 0
D D D D D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H D D D D phenyl 1 pheny l 1
D H D D D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D D H D D phenyl 1 phenyl 1 R3a R3b RD2
R6 R4 No. deuteriums on R4 R5 No. deuteriums on R5
D D D H D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D D D D H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H H D D D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H D H D D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H D D H D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
I I D D D I I phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D H H D D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D H D H D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D H D D H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D D H H D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D D H D H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D D D H H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H H H D D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H H D H D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H H D D H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D H H H D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D H H D H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D D H H H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D H H H H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H D H H H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H H D H H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H H H D H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H H H H D phenyl 1 phenyl 1
H H H H H phenyl 1 phenyl 1
D D D D D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
H D D D D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D H D D D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D D H D D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D D D H D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D D D D H phenyl 2 phenyl 2
H H D D D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
H D H D D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
H D D H D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
H D D D H phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D H H D D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D H D H D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D H D D H phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D D H H D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D D H D H phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D D D H H phenyl 2 phenyl 2
H H H D D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
H H D H D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
I I I I D D I I phenyl 2 phenyl 2 R3a R3b RD2
R6 R4 No. deuteriums on R4 R5 No. deuteriums on R5
D H H H D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D H H D H phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D D H H H phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D H H H H phenyl 2 phenyl 2
H D H H H phenyl 2 phenyl 2
I I I I D I I I I phenyl 2 phenyl 2
H H H D H phenyl 2 phenyl 2
H H H H D phenyl 2 phenyl 2
H H H H H phenyl 2 phenyl 2
D D D D D phenyl - phenyl J
H D D D D phenyl -> phenyl
D H D D D phenyl j phenyl J
D D H D D phenyl - phenyl J
D D D H D phenyl phenyl
D D D D H phenyl phenyl
H H D D D phenyl - phenyl
H D H D D phenyl -> phenyl
H D D H D phenyl phenyl
H D D D H phenyl ->
j) phenyl
D H H D D phenyl -
J phenyl
D H D H D phenyl phenyl
D H D D H phenyl J> phenyl
D D H H D phenyl J phenyl
D D H D H phenyl J phenyl
D D D H H phenyl - J) phenyl
H H H D D phenyl J phenyl
H H D H D phenyl phenyl
H H D D H phenyl "
J) phenyl
D H H H D phenyl phenyl
D H H D H phenyl J phenyl
D D H H H phenyl "
J) phenyl
D H H H H phenyl phenyl
H D H H H phenyl J phenyl
H H D H H phenyl phenyl
H H H D H phenyl 3 phenyl
H H H H D phenyl J phenyl
H H H H H phenyl phenyl
D D D D D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H D D D D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D H D D D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D D H D D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D D D H D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D D D D I I phenyl 4 phenyl 4 R3a R3b RD2
R6 R4 No. deuteriums on R4 R5 No. deuteriums on R5
H H D D D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H D H D D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H D D H D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H D D D H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D H H D D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D I I D I I D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D H D D H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D D H H D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D D H D H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D D D H H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H H H D D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H H D H D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H H D D H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D H H H D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D H H D H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D D H H H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D H H H H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H D H H H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H H D H H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H H H D H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H H H H D phenyl 4 phenyl 4
H H H H H phenyl 4 phenyl 4
D D D D D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H D D D D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D H D D D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D D H D D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D D D H D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D D D D H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H H D D D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H D H D D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H D D H D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H D D D H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D H H D D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D H D H D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D H D D H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D D H H D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D D H D H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D D D H H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H H H D D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H H D H D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H H D D H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D H H H D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D I I I I D I I phenyl 5 phenyl 5 R3a R3b R6 RD2 R4 No. deuteriums on R4 R5 No. deuteriums on R5
D D H H H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
D H H H H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H D H H H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H H D H H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H H H D H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
I I I I I I I I D phenyl 5 phenyl 5
H H H H H phenyl 5 phenyl 5
[0086] In some embodiments of Table A. R can be hydrogen. In other embodiments of Table A, R1 can be deuterium. In still other embodiments of Table A, R1 can be -C(=0)Y' . for example. R1 can be -C(=0)-an optionally substituted Ci-6 alkyl. In some embodiments of Table A, R2 can be an optionally substituted Ci-6 alkyl. In some embodiments of Table A. R1 can be hydrogen and R2 can be an unsubstituted C|_6 alkyl. In other embodiments of Table A, R1 can be -C(=0)C i-6 alkyl and R2 can be an unsubstituted
C i_(, alkyl. In some embodiments of Table A, R1 can be
Figure imgf000043_0001
and R can be isopropyl.
In some embodiments, R and/or R" can include one or more deuterium atoms. For example,
can be deuterium or R can
Figure imgf000043_0002
and/or R~ can be -CH(CH )(CD ) or R* can be -CH(CH3)(CD3).
Synthesis
[0087] Compounds of Formula (I), and those described herein may be prepared in various ways. General synthetic routes to compounds of Formula (I), and some examples of starting materials used to synthesize compounds of Formula (I) are shown and described herein. The routes shown and described herein are illustrative only and are not intended, nor are they to be construed, to limit the scope of the claims in any manner whatsoever. Those skilled in the art will be able to recognize modifications of the disclosed syntheses and to devise alternate routes based on the disclosures herein; all such modifications and alternate routes are within the scope of the claims. 0088] Compounds of Formula (I) can be prepared starting from various protected
Figure imgf000044_0001
Intermediate A Intermediate B
Bn = benzyl
SEM = [2-(Trimethylsilyl)ethoxy]methyl
[0089] Methods for forming a compound of Formula (1) starting from an intermediate and an amino alcohol shown herein, such as Intermediate A or Intermediate B. is shown in Schemes 1 , 2. 3, 4. 5 and 6. In Schemes 1 , 2 and 3, R2a. R4d and R^ can be the same as R2, R4 and Rs as described herein for Formula (1), PG1 can be a benzyl or SEM group and LG1 can be a leaving group.
Scheme 1
Figure imgf000044_0002
b c
[0090] As shown in Scheme 1 , Intermediate A or Intermediate B can be coupled with a 1 ,2-amino alcohol. Examples of suitable reaction conditions for coupling the aforementioned intermediate with a 1 ,2-amino alcohol include, but are not limited to, a carbodiimide (for example, N N'-dicyclohexylcarbodiimide (DCC), Ν, Ν'- diisopropylcarbodiimidc (DIC) or l -ethyl-3-(3-dimcthylaminopropyl)carbodiimide (EDCI)); 0-(7-azabenzotriazol- l -y -N.N Y'.N'-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate (HATU), O- benzotriazole-N,N,N'.N'-tetramethyl-uronimn-hexafluoro-phosphate (HBTU) or O- (benzotriazol-l -yl)-N,N,N'.N'-tetramethyluronium tetrafluoro borate (TBTU) in the presence of an amine base (such as N,N-diisopropylethylamine (DIPEA) or triethylamine (TEA)) in DMF; and propylphosphonic anhydride (T3P) in the presence of an amine base (such as those described herein).
[0091] The hydrogen of the unprotected secondary7 alcohol of compound a can be replaced to provide a suitable leaving group moiety. Suitable leaving groups are known to those skilled in the art. In some embodiments, the leaving group can be 1, Br, CI, a mesyl moiety and/or a tosyl moiety.
[0092] The PG1 and the SEM group attached to the nitrogen of compound b can be removed using methods known to those skilled in the art. For example, the benzyl group can be removed via hydrogenolysis. Hydrogenolysis can be accomplished using various methods, such as a Pd or Pt catalyst (e.g., Pd/C or Pt0 ) in combination with a hydrogen source (e.g., I I2 or formic acid), a strong acid, oxidation to the benzoate and subsequent hydrolysis under basic conditions and 2,3-dichloro-5,6-dicyano-/?-benzoquinone (DDQ). The SEM group(s) can be removed using concentrated HF, tetra-n-butylammonium fluoride (TBAF). cesium fluoride, lithium tetrafluoroborate. trifluoroacetic acid (TFA) or pyridinium p-toluene sulfonate in ethanol at reflux temperature.
[0093] The leaving group moiety, OLG 1. can be removed and the compound can undergo cyclization using an acid or a base to form a compound of Formula (1). Suitable acids and bases are known to those skilled in the art. In some embodiments, the base can be potassium carbonate. Additional bases include sodium carbonate, calcium carbonate, cesium carbonate, sodium bicarbonate, potassium bicarbonate, calcium carbonate, cesium carbonate, triethylamine, diisopropyl ethyl amine, pyridine, KOH and NaOH. Suitable acids include sulfonic acids (e.g., methane sulfonic acid and p-toluenesulfonic acid), trifluoroacetic acid (TFA) and HQ. In some cases, the reagent(s) used to remove the PG1 and SEM groups, for example, cesium fluoride or tetra-n-butylammonium fluoride (TBAF), can then promote cyclization to a compound of Formula (I).
Scheme 2
Figure imgf000046_0001
[0094] As shown in Scheme 2, the PG 1 and the SEM groups attached to the nitrogen can be removed from compound d using one or more methods described herein. A compound of Formula (T) can be then formed via a Mitsunobu ring-closure cyclization. The Mitsunobu ring-closure cyclization can be accomplished using a phosphine reagent (for example, triphenylphosphine. a tri-alkyl phosphine. a tri-aryl phosphine or polymer- supported triphenylphosphine) in combination with an azodicarboxylate. such as diethyl azodicarboxylate (DEAD) or diisopropyl azodicarboxylate (DIAD). Alternatively, the PG1 and the SEM groups can be removed and the ring closed to form a compound of Formula (1) in a single step using a suitable acid, for example, trifluoroacetic acid, at an elevated temperature.
Scheme 3
Figure imgf000047_0001
[0095] In Scheme 3, compound a can be formed as described herein. The secondary alcohol can be oxidized to a ketone using reagent(s) and conditions known to those skilled in the art. Examples of suitable oxidizing reagents and conditions include, but arc not limited to. Dess-Martin periodinane. 1BX (2-iodoxybenzoic acid), TPAP/NMO (tetrapropylammonium perruthenate/N-methylmorpholine N-oxide). Swern oxidation reagent, PCC (pyridinium chlorochromate). PDC (pyridinium dichromate), sodium periodate. Collin's reagent, Corey-Kim's reagent, Moffatt reagent. Jones" reagent. Oppenauer's reagent, eerie ammonium nitrate (CAN), Na2Cr?07 in water. Ag2C03 on celite, hot HN03 in aqueous glyme. 02 -pyridine CuCl, Pb(OAc)4-pyridine, potassium dichromate, and benzoyl peroxide- NiBr2.
[00961 The PG1 and the SEM group attached to the nitrogen can be removed using one or more methods described herein to provide compound g. The six-membered ring can be formed under acidic condition to provide a compound of Formula (I), wherein is a double bond. Examples of suitable acids include, but are not limited to, sulfonic acids (e.g., methane sulfonic acid and p-toluenesulfonic acid), sulfuric acid, trifluoroacetic acid (TFA) and HC1. The double bond can be hydrogenated to a single bond using hydrogen gas in the presence of a palladium or platinum catalyst (such as Pd/C or Pt02).
[0097] Amino alcohols that can be used in the preparation of a compound of Formula (I) can be commercially obtained or prepared according to a procedure provided herein, for example, a procedure shown in Schemes 4-6.
Scheme 4
Figure imgf000048_0001
[0098] As shown in Scheme 4, the ketone undergoes olefination using an alkoxy- based phosphonium halide under Wittig-type reaction conditions to form a vinyl alkoxy intermediate. The vinyl alkoxy intermediate can be hydrolyzcd to an aldehyde using methods known to those skilled in the art. such as perchloric acid. Nitromethane can be added to the aldehyde via a nitro-aldol reaction. Utilizing methods and conditions known to those skilled in the art, the nitro group can be reduced to a NH2 group. The NPF group can undergo reductive alkylation to form the amino alcohol.
Scheme 5
Figure imgf000048_0002
[0099] Another method for forming the amino alcohol is shown in Scheme 5. An amino acid ester can be added to the anion of the starting material, generated using a method known to those skilled in the art, for example, using n-BuLi. The ketone can be reduced to a hydroxy group using one or more suitable reagents and conditions, such as those described herein. To minimize side reactions and/or facilitate the reaction(s). the nitrogen of the amino acid ester can be protected with a suitable protecting group. The protecting group can be removed before or after reduction of the ketone using methods known to those skilled in the art.
Scheme 6
Figure imgf000049_0001
[0100] Scheme 6 shows a further method for forming the amino alcohol. The amino alcohol can be formed by a directed lithiation followed by a condensation-type reaction, using a method known to those skilled in the art, Snieckus et. al.. Tet. Lett. (1994) 35(24):4067-4070.
Pharmaceutical Compositions
[0101] Some embodiments described herein relate to a pharmaceutical composition, that can include an effective amount of one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (Γ), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, diluent, excipient or combination thereof.
[0102] The term "pharmaceutical composition''' refers to a mixture of one or more compounds disclosed herein with other chemical components, such as diluents or carriers. The pharmaceutical composition facilitates administration of the compound to an organism. Pharmaceutical compositions can also be obtained by reacting compounds with inorganic or organic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, nitric acid, phosphoric acid, methanesulfonic acid, ethanesulfonic acid, p-toluenesulfonic acid, and salicylic acid. Pharmaceutical compositions will generally be tailored to the specific intended route of administration. [0103] The term "physiologically acceptable" defines a carrier, diluent or excipient that does not abrogate the biological activity and properties of the compound.
[0104] As used herein, a "carrier" refers to a compound that facilitates the incorporation of a compound into cells or tissues. For example, without limitation, dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO) is a commonly utilized carrier that facilitates the uptake of many organic compounds into cells or tissues of a subject.
[0105] As used herein, a "diluent"' refers to an ingredient in a pharmaceutical composition that lacks pharmacological activity but may be pharmaceutically necessary or desirable. For example, a diluent may be used to increase the bulk of a potent drug whose mass is too small for manufacture and/or administration. It may also be a liquid for the dissolution of a drug to be administered by injection, ingestion or inhalation. A common form of diluent in the art is a buffered aqueous solution such as, w ithout limitation, phosphate buffered saline that mimics the composition of human blood.
[0106] As used herein, an "excipient*" refers to an inert substance that is added to a pharmaceutical composition to provide, without limitation, bulk, consistency, stability, binding ability, lubrication, disintegrating ability etc., to the composition. A "diluent" is a type of excipient.
[0107] The pharmaceutical compositions described herein can be administered to a human patient per se, or in pharmaceutical compositions where they are mixed with other active ingredients, as in combination therapy, or carriers, diluents, excipients or combinations thereof. Proper formulation is dependent upon the route of administration chosen. Techniques for formulation and administration of the compounds described herein are known to those skilled in the art.
[0108] The pharmaceutical compositions disclosed herein may be manufactured in a manner that is itself known, e.g.. by means of conventional mixing, dissolving, granulating, dragee-making, levigating, emulsifying, encapsulating, entrapping or tableting processes. Additionally, the active ingredients are contained in an amount effective to achieve its intended purpose. Many of the compounds used in the pharmaceutical combinations disclosed herein may be provided as salts with pharmaceutically compatible counterions. [0109] Multiple techniques of administering a compound exist in the art including, but not limited to, oral, rectal, topical, aerosol, injection and parenteral delivery, including intramuscular, subcutaneous, intravenous, intramedullary injections, intrathecal, direct intraventricular, intraperitoneal, intranasal and intraocular injections. In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g.. a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be administering intramuscular. In other embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be administering intranasal. In still other embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be administering intradermal. In yet still other embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g.. a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be administering orally .
[01 10] When administered orally, one or more compounds described herein (e.g.. a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be formulated as tablets, pills, dragees. capsules, liquids, gels, syrups, slurries, suspensions and the like, for oral ingestion by a subject to be treated. Injectables can be prepared in conventional forms, either as liquid solutions or suspensions, solid forms suitable for solution or suspension in liquid prior to injection, or as emulsions. Pharmaceutical compositions for intranasal delivery may also include drops and sprays often prepared to assist in simulating nasal secretions.
[0111] One may also administer the compound in a local rather than systemic manner, for example, via injection of the compound directly into the infected area, often in a depot or sustained release formulation. Furthermore, one may administer the compound in a targeted drug delivery system, for example, in a liposome coated with a tissue-specific antibody. The liposomes will be targeted to and taken up selectively by the organ.
[0112] The compositions may. if desired, be presented in a pack or dispenser device which may contain one or more unit dosage forms containing the active ingredient. The pack may for example comprise metal or plastic foil, such as a blister pack. The pack or dispenser device may be accompanied by instructions for administration. The pack or dispenser may also be accompanied with a notice associated with the container in form prescribed by a governmental agency regulating the manufacture, use, or sale of pharmaceuticals, which notice is reflective of approval by the agency of the form of the drug for human or veterinary7 administration. Such notice, for example, may be the labeling approved by the U.S. Food and Drug Administration for prescription drugs, or the approved product insert. Compositions that can include a compound described herein formulated in a compatible pharmaceutical carrier may also be prepared, placed in an appropriate container, and labeled for treatment of an indicated condition.
Methods of Use:
[0113] Some embodiments described herein relate to a method of ameliorating, treating and/or preventing an orthomyxovirus infection, which can include administering an effective amount of one or more compounds described herein, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g.. a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof).
[01 14] Other embodiments described herein relate to a method of inhibiting an orthomyxovirus viral replication, which can include contacting a cell infected with the orthomyxovirus virus with an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereoi).
[0115] In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used to treat and/or ameliorate an influenza viral infection. In other embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used to prevent an influenza viral infection.
[01 16] In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (Γ), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used to inhibit the replication an influenza virus. In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used to inhibit the influenza polymerase complex. In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used for inhibiting and/or reducing the endonuclease activity of an influenza endonuclease that can include contacting the active site of the endonuclease with a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. In some embodiments, one or more compounds described herein inhibits and/or reduces the ability of the endonuclease to cleave the mRNA.
[0117] In some embodiments, including those embodiments in the previous paragraphs, the influenza viral infection can be an influenza A viral infection. In other embodiments, including those embodiments in the previous paragraphs, the influenza viral infection can be an influenza B viral infection. In still other embodiments, including those embodiments in the previous paragraphs, the influenza viral infection can be an influenza C viral infection. In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be used to treat and/or ameliorate one or more subtypes of influenza. For example, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be used to treat H 1N1 and/or H3N2. In addition or in the alternative, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be used to treat H2N2. H5N1 and/or H7N9. In some embodiments, a compound described herein (a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be effective against more than 1 subtype of influenza. For example, a compound described herein (a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof can be effective against 2. 3, 4, and/or 5 or more subtypes of influenza.
[0118] In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used treat and/or ameliorate an upper respiratory viral infection attributed to (directly and/or indirectly) an influenza virus infection. In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used treat and/or ameliorate a lower respiratory viral infection (directly and/or indirectly) an influenza virus infection. In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g.. a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used treat and/or ameliorate one or more symptoms of an influenza virus infection (such as those described herein). In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used treat and/or ameliorate bronchiolitis and/or tracheobronchitis due to an influenza virus infection. In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used treat and/or ameliorate pneumonia due to an influenza virus infection. In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g.. a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used treat and/or ameliorate coup due to an influenza virus infection.
[01 19] In some embodiments, an effective amount of one or more compounds of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and/or a pharmaceutical composition that includes one or more compounds described herein (e.g., a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof) can be used lessen the severity of one or more symptoms of an influenza infection. Examples of symptoms include, but are not limited to, the following: fever, chills, cough, sore throat, runny nose, stuffy nose, muscle aches, body aches, headache, fatigue, vomiting and/or diarrhea.
[0120] As used herein, the terms "prevent"' and "preventing," mean a subject does not develop an infection because the subject has an immunity against the infection, or if a subject becomes infected, the severity of the disease is less compared to the severity of the disease if the subject has not been administered/received the compound. Examples of forms of prevention include prophylactic administration to a subject who has been or may be exposed to an infectious agent, such as an orthomyxovirus (e.g., an influenza virus).
[0121 ] As used herein, the terms "treat." "treating,'" "treatment." "therapeutic," and "therapy" do not necessarily mean total cure or abolition of the disease or condition. Any alleviation of any undesired signs or symptoms of a disease or condition, to any extent can be considered treatment and/or therapy. Furthermore, treatment may include acts that may worsen the subject's overall feeling of well-being or appearance.
[0122] The terms "'therapeutically effective amount" and "effective amount" are used to indicate an amount of an active compound, or pharmaceutical agent, that elicits the biological or medicinal response indicated. For example, a therapeutically effective amount of compound can be the amount needed to prevent, alleviate or ameliorate symptoms of disease or prolong the survival of the subject being treated This response may occur in a tissue, system, animal or human and includes alleviation of the signs or symptoms of the disease being treated. Determination of an effective amount is well within the capability of those skilled in the art, in view of the disclosure provided herein. The therapeutically effective amount of the compounds disclosed herein required as a dose will depend on the route of administration, the type of animal, including human, being treated, and the physical characteristics of the specific animal under consideration. The dose can be tailored to achieve a desired effect, but will depend on such factors as weight, diet, concurrent medication and other factors which those skilled in the medical arts w ill recognize.
[0123] As used herein, a "subject" refers to an animal that is the object of treatment, observation or experiment. "Animal" includes cold- and warm-blooded vertebrates and invertebrates such as fish, shellfish, reptiles and. in particular, mammals. "Mammal" includes, without limitation, mice, rats, rabbits, guinea pigs, dogs, cats, sheep, goats, cows, horses, primates, such as monkeys, chimpanzees, and apes, and, in particular, humans. In some embodiments, the subject is human.
[0124] Various indicators for determining the effectiveness of a method for treating an orthomyxovirus viral infection are known to those skilled in the art. Example of suitable indicators include, but are not limited to, a reduction in viral load, a reduction in viral replication, a reduction in time to seroconversion (virus undetectable in patient serum), a reduction of morbidity or mortality in clinical outcomes, and/or other indicator of disease response.
[0125] In some embodiments, an effective amount of a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, is an amount that is effective to reduce viral titers to a lower level, for example, from about 10E4 TCID50/mL(TCID = tissue culture infectious dose) to about 10E3 TCID50/mL, or to about 100 TCID50/mL, or to about 10 TCTD50/mL. In some embodiments, an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, is an amount that is effective to reduce viral load compared to the viral load before administration of the compound of Formula (Γ), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. For example, w7herein the viral load is measure before administration of the compound of Formula (Γ). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and again after initiation of the treatment regime with the compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof (for example, 10 days after initiation of treatment). In some embodiments, an effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be an amount that is effective to reduce viral load to lower than about 10E4 TCID50/mL. In some embodiments, an effective amount of a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, is an amount that is effective to achieve a reduction in viral titer in a nasal/pharyngeal swab or nasal wash sample of the subject in the range of about 1 .5-log to about a 2.5-log reduction or about a 3-log to about a 4-log reduction compared to the viral load before administration of the compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. For example, wherein the viral load is measure before administration of the compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and again after initiation of the treatment regime with the compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof (for example, 10 days after initiation of treatment).
[0126] In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing, can result in one or more overall quality of life health, such as reduced illness duration, reduced illness severity, reduced time to return to normal health and normal activity, and reduced time to alleviation of one or more symptoms of orthomyxovirus infection, compared to a subject who is untreated. In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing, can result in a reduction in the length and/or severity of one or more symptoms associated with an orthomyxovirus infection compared to an untreated subject. Symptoms of an orthomyxovirus infection are described herein and include but not limited to cough, myalgia (muscle pain), nasal obstruction, sore throat, fatigue, headache and fever. In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (Γ), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the thereof, can result in a reduction in one or more secondary complications associated with an orthomyxovirus infection, including but not limited to otitis media (ear inflammation), sinusitis, bronchitis and pneumonia compared to an untreated subject.
[0127] In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing, can result in at least a 1 , 2, 3, 4, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 50, 75, 100-fold or more reduction in the replication of an orthomyxovirus relative to pre-treatment levels in a subject, as determined after initiation of the treatment regime (for example, 10 days after initiation of treatment). In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing, can result in a reduction of the replication of an orthomyxovirus relative to pre -treatment levels in the range of about 2 to about 5 fold, about 10 to about 20 fold, about 15 to about 40 fold, or about 50 to about 100 fold. In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can result in a reduction of orthomyxovirus replication in the range of 1 to 1 .5 log. 1 .5 log to 2 log. 2 log to 2.5 log, 2.5 to 3 log, or 3 to 3.5 log reduction of orthomyxovirus replication compared to the reduction of orthomyxovirus reduction achieved by oseltamivir (Tamiflu®). or may achieve the same reduction as that of oseltamivir (Tamiflu®) therapy in a shorter period of time, for example, in one day, two days, three days, or four days as compared to the reduction achieved after 5 days of oseltamivir (Tamiflu® ) therapy.
[0128] After a period of time, infectious agents can develop resistance to one or more therapeutic agents. The term "resistance"' as used herein refers to a viral strain displaying a delayed, lessened and/or null response to a therapeutic agent(s). For example, after treatment with an antiviral agent, the viral load of a subject infected with a resistant virus may be reduced to a lesser degree compared to the amount in viral load reduction exhibited by a subject infected with a non-resistant strain. In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be administered to a subject infected with an influenza virus that is resistant to one or more different anti- influenza agents (for example, amantadine, rimantadine and/or oseltamivir). In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be administered to a subject infected with an influenza virus that is resistant to a M2 protein inhibitor. In some embodiments, development of resistant influenza strains is delayed when subjects are treated with a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, compared to the development of influenza strains resistant to other influenza drugs.
[0129| In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can decrease the percentage of subjects that experience complications from an influenza viral infection compared to the percentage of subjects that experience complication being treated with oseltamivir. For example, the percentage of subjects being treated with a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, that experience complications can be 10%, 25%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80% and 90% less compared to subjects being treated with oseltamivir.
[0130] In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes a compound described herein, can be used in combination with one or more additional agent(s). In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be used in combination with one or more agents currently used in a conventional standard of care for treating influenza. For example, the additional agent can be amantadine (adamantan-
1 - amine, Symmetrel), rimantadine (Flumadine), zanamivir (Relenza) and oseltamivir (Tamiflu). For the treatment of influenza, additional agents include but are not limited to a neuraminidase inhibitor, a M2 protein inhibitor, a polymerase inhibitor, a PB2 inhibitor, peramivir (( 1 S,2S,3S,4R)-3-[( 1 S)- 1 -acetamido-2-ethylbutyl]-4-(diaminomethyiideneamino)-
2- hydroxycyclopentane-l-carboxylic acid, BioCryst Pharmaceuticals), laninamivir ((4S,5R,6R)-5-acetamido-4-carbamimidamido-6-[(lR,2R)-3-hydroxy-2-methoxypropyl]-5,6- dihydro-4H-pyran-2-carboxylic acid), favipiravir (T-705, 6-fluoro-3-hydroxy-2- pyrazinecarboxamide), laninamivir octanoate ((3R,4S)-3-acetamido-4-guanidino-2-((l S,2S)- 2 -hydroxy- 1 -methoxy-3-(octanoy loxy)propyl)-3,4-dihydro-2I I-pyran-6-carboxylic acid) fludase (DAS 1 81 , NexBio), ADS-8902 (amantadine HCl/oseltamivir/ribavirin, Adamas Pharmaceuticals), an immuno-modulator (for example, a Type 1 interferon), beraprost (4-[2- hydroxy- 1 -[(E)-3-hydroxy-4-methyloct- 1 -en-6-ynyl]-2,3,3a,8b-tetrahydro- 1 H- cyclopcnta[bJ [l ]bcnzofuran-5-yl]butanoic acid), Neugcne®, ribavirin, (R)-3-((5-fluoro-2-(5- fluoro- l H-pyrrolo[2.3-b]pyridin-3-yl)pyrimidin-4-yl)amino)-4,4-dimethylpentanoic acid (CAS Reg. No. 1422050-75-6), (2S,3S)-3-((5-fluoro-2-(5-fIuoro-l H-pyrrolo[2.3-b]pyridin-3- yl)pyrimidin-4-yl)amino)bicyclo[2.2.2]octane-2-carboxylic acid (CAS Reg. No. 1259366-34- 1. VX-787). FluMist Quadrivalent® (Medlmmune). Fluarix® Quadrivalent (GlaxoSmithKline), Fluzone® Quadrivalent (Sanofi Pasteur), Flucelvax® (Novartis) and FluBlok® (Protein Sciences). In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition that includes a compound described herein, can be used in combination with oseltamivir. [0131] Type 1 interferons are known to those skilled in the art. A non-limiting list of examples include: alpha-interferons, beta-interferons, delta-interferons, omega- interferons, tau-interferons, x-interferons. consensus interferons and asialo-interferons. Type 1 interferons can be pegylated. Examples of specific type 1 interferons include interferon alpha 1 A, interferon alpha I B. interferon alpha 2A. interferon alpha 2B. pegylated-interferon alpha 2a (PEGASYS, Roche), recombinant interferon alpha 2a (ROFERON, Roche), inhaled interferon alpha 2b (AERX. Aradigm), pegylated-interferon alpha 2b (ALBUFERON, Human Genome Sciences/Novartis, PEGINTRON. Schering). recombinant interferon alpha 2b (INTRON A. Schering). pegylated interferon alpha 2b (PEG-INTRON. Schering, V1RAFERONPEG, Schering), interferon beta- la (REB1F, Serono, Inc. and Pfizer), consensus interferon alpha (1NFERGEN, Valeant Pharmaceutical).
[0132| In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be administered with one or more additional agent(s) together in a single pharmaceutical composition. In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be administered with one or more additional agent(s) as two or more separate pharmaceutical compositions. For example, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be administered in one pharmaceutical composition, and at least one of the additional agents can be administered in a second pharmaceutical composition. If there are at least two additional agents, one or more of the additional agents can be in a first pharmaceutical composition that includes a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and at least one of the other additional agent(s) can be in a second pharmaceutical composition.
[0133] The order of administration of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, with one or more additional agent(s) can vary. In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be administered prior to all additional agents. In other embodiments, a compound of Formula (Γ), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be administered prior to at least one additional agent. In still other embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be administered concomitantly with one or more additional agent(s). In yet still other embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, can be administered subsequent to the administration of at least one additional agent. In some embodiments, a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceuticallv acceptable salt thereof, can be administered subsequent to the administration of all additional agents.
[0134] In some embodiments, the combination of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more additional agent(s) can result in an additive effect. In some embodiments, the combination of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more additional agent(s) can result in a synergistic effect. In some embodiments, the combination of a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more additional agent(s) can result in a strongly synergistic effect. In some embodiments, the combination of a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more additional agent(s) is not antagonistic.
[0135] As used herein, the term "antagonistic" means that the activity of the combination of compounds is less compared to the sum of the activities of the compounds in combination when the activity of each compound is determined individually (i.e. as a single compound). As used herein, the term "synergistic effect" means that the activity of the combination of compounds is greater than the sum of the individual activities of the compounds in the combination when the activity of each compound is determined individually. As used herein, the term "additive effect" means that the activity of the combination of compounds is about equal to the sum of the individual activities of the compound in the combination when the activity of each compound is determined individually.
[0136] A potential advantage of utilizing a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more of the additional agent(s) described above, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof, may be a reduction in the required amount(s) of the one or more additional agents, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof, that is effective in treating a disease condition disclosed herein (for example, influenza), as compared to the amount required to achieve the same therapeutic result when one or more of the additional agents, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof, are administered without a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. For example, the amount of an additional agent described above, including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt and prodrug thereof, can be less when administered in combination with a compound of Formula (1). or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, compared to the amount of additional agent, including a pharmaceutically acceptable salt and prodrug thereof, needed to achieve the same viral load reduction when administered as a monotherapy. Another potential advantage of utilizing a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more of the additional agent(s) described above, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof, is that the use of two or more compounds having different mechanisms of action can create a higher barrier to the development of resistant viral strains compared to the barrier when a compound is administered as monotherapy.
[0137] Additional advantages of utilizing a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with one or more of the additional agent(s) described above, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof, may include little to no cross resistance between a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and the one or more additional agent(s) described above (including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof); different routes for elimination of a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and the one or more additional agent(s) described above (including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof); little to no overlapping toxicities between a compound of Formula (1), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and the one or more additional agent(s) described above (including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof); little to no significant effects on cytochrome P450; and/or little to no pharmacokinetic interactions between a compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and the one or more additional agent(s) described above, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts and prodrugs thereof. [0138] As will be readily apparent to one skilled in the art, the useful in vivo dosage to be administered and the particular mode of administration will vary depending upon the age, weight, the severity of the affliction, and mammalian species treated, the particular compounds employed, and the specific use for which these compounds are employed. The determination of effective dosage levels, that is the dosage levels necessary to achieve the desired result, can be accomplished by one skilled in the art using routine methods, for example, human clinical trials and in vitro studies.
[0139] The dosage may range broadly, depending upon the desired effects and the therapeutic indication. Alternatively dosages may be based and calculated upon the surface area of the patient, as understood by those of skill in the art. Although the exact dosage will be determined on a drug-by-drug basis, in most cases, some generalizations regarding the dosage can be made. The daily dosage regimen for an adult human patient may be, for example, an oral dose of between 0.01 mg and 3000 mg of each active ingredient, preferably between 1 mg and 700 mg, e.g. 5 to 200 mg. The dosage may be a single one or a series of two or more given in the course of one or more days, as is needed by the subject. In some embodiments, the compounds will be administered for a period of continuous therapy, for example for a week or more, or for months or years.
[0140] In instances where human dosages for compounds have been established for at least some condition, those same dosages may be used, or dosages that are between about 0.1 % and 500%. more preferably between about 25% and 250% of the established human dosage. Where no human dosage is established, as will be the case for new ly- discovered pharmaceutical compositions, a suitable human dosage can be inferred from ED50 or ID5o values, or other appropriate values derived from in vitro or in vivo studies, as qualified by toxicity studies and efficacy studies in animals.
[0141] In cases of administration of a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, dosages may be calculated as the free base. As will be understood by those of skill in the art, in certain situations it may be necessary to administer the compounds disclosed herein in amounts that exceed, or even far exceed, the above-stated, preferred dosage range in order to effectively and aggressively treat particularly aggressive diseases or infections. [0142] Dosage amount and interval may be adjusted individually to provide plasma levels of the active moiety which are sufficient to maintain the modulating effects, or minimal effective concentration (MEC). The MEC will vary for each compound but can be estimated from in vitro data. Dosages necessary to achieve the MEC will depend on individual characteristics and route of administration. However, HPLC assays or bioassays can be used to determine plasma concentrations. Dosage intervals can also be determined using MEC value. Compositions should be administered using a regimen which maintains plasma levels above the MEC for 1 0-90% of the time, preferably between 30-90% and most preferably between 50-90%. In cases of local administration or selective uptake, the effective local concentration of the drug may not be related to plasma concentration.
[0143| It should be noted that the attending physician would know how7 to and when to terminate, interrupt, or adjust administration due to toxicity or organ dysfunctions. Conversely, the attending physician would also know to adjust treatment to higher levels if the clinical response were not adequate (precluding toxicity). The magnitude of an administrated dose in the management of the disorder of interest will vary with the severity of the condition to be treated and to the route of administration. The severity of the condition may . for example, be evaluated, in part, by standard prognostic evaluation methods. Further, the dose and perhaps dose frequency, will also vary according to the age. body weight, and response of the individual patient. A program comparable to that discussed above may be used in veterinary medicine.
[0144] Compounds disclosed herein can be evaluated for efficacy and toxicity using known methods. For example, the toxicology of a particular compound, or of a subset of the compounds, sharing certain chemical moieties, may be established by determining in vitro toxicity towards a cell line, such as a mammalian, and preferably human, cell line. The results of such studies are often predictive of toxicity in animals, such as mammals, or more specifically, humans. Alternatively, the toxicity of particular compounds in an animal model, such as mice, rats, rabbits, or monkeys, may be determined using known methods. The efficacy of a particular compound may be established using several recognized methods, such as in vitro methods, animal models, or human clinical trials. When selecting a model to determine efficacy, the skilled artisan can be guided by the state of the art to choose an appropriate model, dose, route of administration and/or regime.
EXAMPLES
[0145] Additional embodiments are disclosed in further detail in the following examples, which are not in any way intended to limit the scope of the claims.
EXAMPLE 1A
Synthesis of Compound H
Figure imgf000065_0001
[0146] To a stirred solution of NaH (21.8 g, 912 mmol 3.0 eq.) in THE (300 mL) was added BnOH (32.8 g, 304.0 mmol 1.0 eq.) under a N2 atmosphere at 0 °C. After addition, the mixture was stirred for 30 min. Compound A (63.5 g, 304.0 mmol 1 .0 eq.) was added portionwise. The mixture was allowed to warm to ambient temperature and stirred for another 12 h. The reaction was monitored by TLC (petroleum ether(PE):EtOAc = 5: 1 ). The mixture was poured into 2M HC1 solution to a ~pH 6. The solution was exacted with EtOAc (200 mL x 3). The combined organic phases were dried over NaiS04, filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by column chromatography on silica gel (PErEtOAc = 30: 1 to 5: 1 ) to give compound B as a colorless oil (46 g, 88.5 %). Ή NMR (CDC13) δ 7.39-7.29 (m, 5H), 4.59 (s, 2H). 4. 17-4.24 (q. 2H), 4.14 (s. 2H), 3.53 (s, 2H), 1 .3 1 -1 .22 (t. 3H).
[0147] To a stirred solution of compound B (10.0 g, 42.3 mmol 1 .0 eq.) in CH3CN (20 mL) under a N2 atmosphere at 0 °C. was added TosN3 (8.35 g, 42.3 mmol 1 .0 eq.) and TEA (12.84 g. 127.1 mmol 3.0 eq.). The mixture was stirred at 0°C for 2 h. The mixture was warmed to room temperature (RT) and stirred for 6 h. The reaction was monitored by TLC (PErEtOAc = 5: 1). After complete conversion was observed, the solvent was removed under reduced pressure, and the residue was purified by column chromatography on silica gel (PE:EtOAc = 30: 1 to 5: 1 ) to give compound C as a colorless oil (4.5 g, 40.5%). Ή NMR (CDC ) δ 7.39-7.26 (m, 5H), 4.64 (s, 2H), 4.60 (s, 2H), 4.29-4.24 (q, 2H), 1.32- 1.28 (t, 3H).
[0148] To a solution of compound C (4.04 g, 15.4 mmol 1.0 eq.) in THE (5 mL) was added P(CH3)3/THF solution (16.9 mL, 16.9 mM, 1.1 eq.) at RT. The mixture was stirred for 15 min (indicated by TLC, PE:EtOAc =2: 1 ) and then quenched with water (2.8 mL). The mixture was stirred for 1 5 min and concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude residue was purified by column chromatography on silica gel (PErEtOAc = 5: 1 to 2: 1 ) to give compound D as a yellow solid (4.0 g, 98.2%). Ή NMR (CDC13) δ 7.39-7.24 (m, 5H), 4.66-4.66 (s. l H). 4.66-4.61 (s, 2H), 4.53-4.53 (s, I H). 4.31 -4.24 (m. 2 H), 1 .35- 1 .29 (m. 3H).
[0149] To a stirred solution of compound D (20.0 g, 75.7 mmol. 1 .0 eq.) in THF ( 100 mL) was added NaHC03 (19.1 g, 227.3 mmol 3.0 eq.) and (Boc)20 (22.84 g. 1 13.6 mmol 1 .5 eq.). The mixture was heated to reflux for 6 h and monitored by TLC (PE:EtOAc =2: 1 ). After complete conversion was observed, the solution was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in EtOAc (200 mL) and washed with water (80 mL x 2). The organic layer was separated, dried over Na2S04 and filtered. The mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure, and the residue was purified by column chromatography on silica gel (PE:EtOAc = 8: 1 ) to give compound E as a white solid ( 15 g, 54.30%). Ή NMR (CDC ) δ 1 1 .59 (s, 1 H), 7.40-7.26 (m. 5H). 4.71 -4.61 (m, 2H), 4.39 (s, 2H), 4.71 -4.27 (q, 2H), 1 .70- 1 .48 (m, 9H), 1 .38- 1 .24 (t, 3H).
[0150] To a solution of compound E (4.2 g, 1 1 .5 mmol 1 eq.) in THF ( 100 mL) at RT, was added DMF-DMA (6. 15 g, 5 1 .7 mmol. 4.5 eq.). The mixture was stirred at RT for 16 h. After complete conversion was observed as indicated by TLC, the reaction was treated with water (5-6 mL) and stirred for 30 min. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure at 40-50 °C. The residue was crystallized from EtOAc to give the pure product as a white solid, (0.5 g). The mother liquor was concentrated and purified by column chromatography on silica gel (DCM:MeOH = 50: lto l 0: l ) to give compound F as a solid (2.4 g, total 75.95%). LCMS (ESI) m/z = 275.2 [M+H]+ (calc. = 274.1). Retention Time =1.097 min.
[0151] To a solution of compound F (2.74 g, 10 mmol) and TEA (3.03 g, 30 mmol) in DCM (40 mL) at 0 °C, was added 2-trimethylsilylethyoxymethyl chloride (SEMCl, 2.86 g .20 mmol) dropwise. After addition, the mixture was stirred at 0"C for 1 h. The solution was then slowly warmed to RT and stirred for 2 h. The mixture was quenched, washed with 1 M HC1 aqueous solution (30 mL x 3), saturated aq. NaHC(¾ (20 mL x 2) and water. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried over Na2S04, and concentrated to give a crude oil (3.8 g), which was then purified by column chromatography on silica gel to give compound G as a colorless oil (3.0 g. 74%).
[0152] To a stirred solution of compound G (2.02 g, 5.0 mmol) in MeOH (20 mL) at 0 °C, was added aq. NaOH (1 M, 5 mL) dropwise. After addition, the mixture was stirred for 30 min. MeOH was removed under reduced pressure. The resulting aqueous solution was neutralized with 1 M HC1 to pH ~ 2.0. A white solid was precipitated, which was then filtered, washed writh water and dried in vacuum to get compound H (1 .5 g, 83%) with a high purity. Ή NMR (400 MHz. DMSO-t/ 6): δ 8.88 (s. 1 H). 7.49 - 7.41 (m. 5 H), 5.57 (s. 2 H). 522 (s, 2 H), 3.63 (t, J = 8 Hz, 2H), 0.87 (t, J= 8 Hz, 2H), 0.02 (S, 9 H). EXAMPLE IB
nthesis of Compound F
Figure imgf000068_0001
E F
[0153] To a 100-mL flask with a teflon stir bar was added ethyl diazoacetate (7.81 g; 2.00 eq.). A bubbler was attached to vent gaseous by-products. The reaction was stirred and cooled with an ice bath during the addition of benzy loxyacetyl chloride (5.80 g; 1 .00 eq.) to maintain the internal temperature near room temperature. Using intermittent cooling, the reaction was maintained at 20-25 °C for 70 min, and then stirred at RT overnight. Reaction progress was monitored by TLC (25% EtOAc/hexane; Rp EDA -0.6; Rp product -0.5) and was complete after 12 h. The reaction was diluted with EtOAc (45 mL). transferred to a separatory funnel, and washed successively with sat. aq. potassium carbonate (15 mL) and brine (15 mL). The organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and transferred into a 250-mL flask. Compound C was used without further purification.
[0154] A flask containing Compound C was purged with argon. PMes (30 mL; 1.0 eq.; 1.0 M in THE) was added. The internal temperature was maintained near RT using an ice bath during the addition of PMe3. The reaction was monitored by TLC (25% EtOAc/hexanes; R starting material -0.5; Rp product -0.1) and was determined to be complete after 5 min. The solution was transferred to a separatory funnel and washed with water (2 x 15-mL) and brine, and dried over sodium sulfate. The organic layer was concentrated under reduced pressure to yield compound D (9.63 g) as orange oil.
[0155] Compound D was dissolved in THE (75 mL). NaHCOj (7.51 g; 3.00 eq.) and BocoO (7.07 g; 1 .09 eq.) were added. The mixture was stirred and heated to 60 °C. The reaction was judged complete by TLC after 30 min (50% EtOAc/hex; Rp starting material -0.4, Rp product -0.9). The reaction was cooled to RT, filtered through a coarse-grade fritted glass filter, and washed with EtOAc (40 mL). The filtrate was washed with 1 : 1 brine: water (50 mL), and with brine. The organic layer was dried over sodium sulfate and concentrated under reduced pressure to give a yellow solid that was slurried with hexanes (75 mL) and filtered through a medium-grade fritted glass filter. The solid was slurried with additional hexanes (40 mL) and filtered to dryness (dried at 80 °C) to give compound E (6.60 g, 60.8% yield over 3 steps) as a pale yellow solid.
[0156] A solution of compound E (5.90 g; 1 .0 eq.) in dry THF ( 18 mL) was placed into an addition funnel and added over 5 min to a 60 °C, mechanically stirred solution of /<?r/-butoxy bis(dimethylamino)mefhane (3 eq.) in dry THF (80 mL). After 10 min, the reaction was monitored by TLC (25% LtOAc/hexanes; R| s.m. -0.5; R+ product -baseline) and judged to be complete within 30 min. The reaction was cooled in an ice bath to RT. Portions of 4 M HCl/dioxane (5-mL per portion) were added until samples that come into contact with wetted pH paper register as strongly acidic. During the addition, the temperature of the mixture was maintained near RT with an ice bath. The resulting thick slurry was diluted with THF (35 mL), collected by vacuum filtration (coarse-grade fritted glass filter), and washed with 1 : 1 acetone: water (2 x 17-mL). The filter cake was stirred with acetone (16 mL) and filtered 4 times to give compound F (3.8 g, 85.3%) as a white solid.
EXAMPLE 2
Synthesis of Compound L
Figure imgf000069_0001
K L [0157] To a solution of compound G (9.0 g, 22.2 mmol) in reagent alcohol (1 10 mL) was added 10% Pd on carbon (700 mg; 3 mol %). The reaction flask was vacuum purged with hydrogen, and the suspension was rapidly stirred at RT under a hydrogen atmosphere (balloon pressure) for 2 h (LCMS analysis indicated complete conversion). The mixture was filtered through celite, followed by a rinse using 10% MeOH/CH2Cl2 (50 mL). The filtrate was concentrated to give compound J as a tan crystalline solid (6.9 g) that was used without further purification.
[0158] To a solution of compound J (6.9 g, 22 mmol) and triethylamine (9.2 mL g, 22 mmol) in DCM (80 mL) at 0 "C, was added 2-triniethylsilylethyoxymethyl chloride (SEMCI, 5.27 mL, 29.8 mmol), dropwise. After addition, the ice bath was removed and the mixture was stirred at RT overnight. TLC analysis indicated compound J was still present. Additional 2-trimethylsilylethyoxymethyl chloride (SEMCI. 2 mL, 1 1.2 mmol) was added. TLC analysis after 2 h indicated the reaction was complete. The mixture was quenched with sat. aqueous NH4CI (100 mL) and 2 M HC1 aqueous solution (20 mL, final pH ~7), and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with DCM (80 mL) and the combined organic layers were washed with water, followed by brine, and dried over
Figure imgf000070_0001
The solution was concentrated to give an orange oil that was purified by column chromatography (silica gel; 45-75% EtOAc/hexanes) to give compound K as a colorless oil (7.95 g, 81 %) that solidified on standing.
[0159] To a stirred solution of compound K (7.95 g, 17.9 mmol) in reagent alcohol (120 mL) at RT was added aq. NaOH (2 M, 54 mL. 108 mmol). The mixture was stirred for 3 h (LCMS indicated complete conversion) and was then concentrated to approx. half volume under reduced pressure (45 HC). The mixture was cooled at 0 °C and acidified with 2 M HC1 to pH~2-3 (pH paper). An oily white solid precipitated during the acidification, which was extracted with DCM (150 mL). The layers were separated, and the aqueous layer was extracted with DCM (2 x 50 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried over Na2SC>4, and concentrated to give compound L (6.8 g) as an off-white solid. LCMS: m/z = 415 [M-H]~; Ή NMR (400 MHzCDCL,): δ 8.38 (s, ILL), 5.57 (s, 2H), 5.40 (s, 2H), 3.8 (dd, J = 8.8, 8.8 Hz, 2H), 3.68 (dd, J = 8.4, 8.4 Hz, 2H), 0.965 (dd, J = 16.8, 6.8 Hz, 4H), 0.01 (s, 18H). EXAMPLE 3
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol AA6
Figure imgf000071_0001
AA6
[0160] To a solution of diphenylmethane (250 g, 1 .49 mol) in THF ( 1.5 L) at 0 °C under N2 was added n-BuLi (549 ml, 1 .49 mmol. 2.5 M) dropwise. After addition, the reaction was stirred for 1 h at the same temperature. AcOEt (196 g, 2.23 mol) was added dropwise, and then the mixture was kept stirring at 60 °C for 16 h. The reaction was quenched with water, extracted with EtOAc (3 x 200 mL). The organic phases were washed with brine, dried over anhydrous Na2SC>4, filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel (PE:EA=10: 1 ) to give A-1 as a white solid ( 100 g, yield: 30%). Ή NMR (400 MHz, CDC13): δ 7.41 -7.25 (m, 10 H), 5.15 (s, 1H), 2.28 (s, 3 H).
10161] To a solution of A-1 (50 g, 237 mmol) in AcOH (250 mL) at 60 °C under N2 was added Br2 (38.0 g, 237 mmol) dropwise. After addition (30 min), the mixture was stirred at the same temperature for 1 h. The solution was then cooled to RT and then poured into ice-water (250 mL). The reaction was quenched with saturated aq. NaiSO . The mixture was extracted with DCM (3 x 250 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with aq. NaI IC03 and brine, and dried over Na2S04. The mixture was filtered and concentrated. To the residue was added with PE (200 mL). The mixture was violently stirred for 20 mins and then filtered. The filtrate cake was washed with PE and dried in vacuum to provide crude A-2 as a white solid (52 g), which was used directly in the next step without further purification.
[0162] To a solution of A-2 (52.0 g, 179 mmol) in ΤΗΓ (300 mL) at 0 "C, was added NaBlT; (27.2 g. 719 mmol) in portions. After addition, the reaction was kept stirring for 2 h at RT. The reaction was quenched with water and extracted with EtOAc (3 x 200 mL). The organic phases were washed with brine, dried over Na2SC>4 and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel (PE:EA=10: 1 ) to give A-3 as a white solid (30 g, yield: 57.7%). Ή NMR (400 MHz, CDC13): δ 7.41 -7.21 (m. 10 H). 4.58-4.52 (tn, 1 H), 4.1 6-4.13 (d, J=12, 1 H), 3.57-3.53 (m, 1 H), 3.36-3.32 (m. 1H).
[0163] To a stirred solution of A-3 (30.0 g. 103 mmol) in MeOH (30 mL) was added K2CO3 (42.7 g, 309 mmol) at RT. The reaction was monitored by TLC (PE:EtOAc = 10: 1 ). After 10 mins, the mixture was filtered. The filtrate cake was washed with MeOH ( 10 mL). The combined filtrates were concentrated to give a crude residue, which was purified by silica column chromatograph (PE:EA=50: 1 ) give A-4 as a colorless oil ( 15 g, yield: 71.4%). Ή NMR (400 MHz, CDC13): δ 7.38-7.28 (m, 10 H), 3.90-3.88 (d, J=8, 1H), 3.58- 3.55 (m, 1 H), 2.91-2.89 (t, J=4, 1H), 2.58-2.56 (m, lH).
[0164] Compound A-5 was prepared according to the procedure described in Gopishetty et. al.. Tetrahedron: Asymmetry (201 1 ) 22( 10): 1081 - 1086, which is hereby incorporated by reference for the limited purpose of its disclosure of the preparation of A-5.
[0165] To a solution of A-5 (800 mg, 3.8 mmol) in MeOH ( 10 mL) in a screw-top tube, was added MeNHi/MeOH ( 10 mL) in one portion. The mixture was stirred at RT for 30 min. The mixture was then heated to 60 "C and stirred for 5 h. The mixture was cooled to RT, and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure to give AA6 as a yellowish solid (850 mg), which was used without further purification. ESl-MS: m/z = 241 .8 [M+H]+. Optionally, A-4 can be substituted for compound A-5. leading to amino alcohol AA6 as a racemic mixture.
[0166] 1 -(3-cyclopropoxyphenyi)-3-(methylamino)-l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 3 and using l -benzyl-3- cyclopropoxybenzene. [0167] l -(methylamino)-3,4-diphenylbutan-2-ol was prepared followin procedure as in Example 3 starting from step 2 and using 3,4-diphenylbutan-2-one.
EXAMPLE 4
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol (AA1)
Figure imgf000073_0001
10168] To a solution of B-2 (25 g, 0.17 mol) and K2CO3 (97.3 g, 0.7 mmol) in DMF (500 mL) was added B-l ( 19 g, 0.14 mol). The mixture was stirred for 2 h at 150 °C. The solution was poured into ice-water (2 L). The suspension was extracted with EtOAc (3 x 500 mL). The organic layers were washed with brine (2 x 300 niL), dried with Na?S04 and concentrated to give B-3 (45 g), which was used directly in the next step. Ή NMR (400 MHz, d-DMSO): δ 13.08 (s, 1 H), 7.83 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1 H), 7.45-7.39 (m, 5H), 7.27 (m, 1H), 7.14 (m. 1 IT), 4.61 (s, 2H).
[0169] A solution of B-3 (45 g, 0.16 mol) in polyphosphoric acid (PPA, 400 mL) was stirred at 150 "C for 3 h. The mixture was then slowly poured into 2 L of ice-water, and a white solid precipitated. The suspension was allowed to stand for 1 h. and then filtered. The solid was dried under vacuum to give B-4 ( 18 g, 48 %). The filtrate was extracted with EtOAc. The organic layers were washed with brine, dried and concentrated. The residue was purified by re-crystallization (in EtOAc) to give additional B-4 (2.0 g) that was combined with the first batch of materials. Ή NMR (400 MHz. J-DMSO): δ 8.03 (dd, J = 8 Hz, J = 1.2 Hz, 1 H), 7.70 (d, J = 1 .2 Hz, l H), 7.70 (t, J = 1 .2 Hz, 1 H). 7.44-7.35 (m, 4H), 4.30 (s, 2H).
[0170] To a mixture of (methoxymethyl) triphenylphosphonium chloride (43 g. 127 mmol) in THT (400 mL) was added n-BuLi (2.5 M, 51 mL. 127 mmol) dropwise at 0 °C. A solution of B-4 (6.6 g, 25.38 mmol) in THT (50 mL) was added. The mixture was stirred for 5 h at 0 °C. The mixture was warmed to room temperature and then stirred overnight. The mixture was quenched with sat. aq. NH4CI. The solution was extracted with EtOAc (3 x 200 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine, dried over with Mg2S04 and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash column chromatography on silica gel to give compound B-5 as a colorless oil (6.0 g, a mixture of E/Z isomers, 82 %). Ή NMR (400 MHz, CDCL,): δ 7.30-7.28 (m, lH), 7.16-7.07 (m, 5H), 6.90 (t, J = 8 Hz, 1 H), 6.10 (s, 1H), 4.50 (brs, 2H), 3.66 (s, 3H).
[0171] To a solution of B-5 (7 g, 24.3 mmol) in 1 ,4-dioxane (30 mL) was added HCIO4 (70% aq., 5 mL). The mixture was stirred for 30 min at 90 UC. The reaction was cooled to RT, diluted with water (150 mL) and extracted with EtOAc (2 x 50 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried over Na2S04 and concentrated to give B-6 (7.5 g), which was used directly in the next step. Ή NMR (400 MI Iz, CDC13): δ 9.87 (s, 1H), 7.36-7.18 (m, 8H), 4.59 (s, 1 H), 4.13 (d, J = 16 Hz, 1 H), 3.91 (d. J = 16 Hz, 1 H).
[0172] A mixture of B-6 (7.5 g, 27 mmol) and potassium carbonate (37.94 g. 273 mmol) in nitromethane (30 mL) was stirred for 3 h at 25 °C. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. To the residue was added EtOAc (200 mL) and water (100 mL). The separated organic phase was washed with brine (2 x 50 mL), dried and concentrated. The residue was purified by silica column chromatography (pet ether:EtOAc=10: l ) to give B-7 as colorless oil (mixture of diastereoisomers, 4 g, 44%).
[0173] To a solution of B-7 (4.1 g, 12.2 mmol) in HOAc (30 mL). was added zinc powder (31.7 g, 489 mmol), and the mixture was stirred for 13 h at 25 °C. The mixture was filtered through a pad of celite to give a clear solution, which was poured into ice-water (100 mL). The mixture was basified with K2CO3 to pH~10, and extracted with EtOAc (3 x 100 mL). The organic layer was washed with brine (2 x 50 mL). dried over with Na2S04 and concentrated to give amino alcohol AA1 as a pale yellow solid (3 g, 81%). LCIV1S: m/z 306 [M+I I]+.
EXAMPLE 5
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol (AA2)
Figure imgf000075_0001
I0174] To a solution of B-9 (45.3 g, 0.29 mol), Pd (OAc)2 (3.2 g. 14.3 mmol) and Na2C03 (48 g, 0.46 mol) in PEG:H20 (600 mL, v/v = 1 : 1), was added B-8 (50.7 g, 0.29 mol) portionwise at 0 °C for 20 min. The mixture was stirred at 80 °C for 1 h, and then extracted with EtOAc (3 x 500 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with brine (2 x 300 mL), dried with a2S04 and concentrated to give a residue. The residue was purified by silica gel chromatography (PE:EA= 100: 1 to 20: 1 ) to provide B-10 as a white solid (20 g, 27%). Ή NMR (400 MHz, CD3C1): δ 7.78 (s. I l l), 7.66 (d, J=7.7 I Iz, I I I). 7.60 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1 H), 7.49 - 7.43 (m, 1 H).
[0175] To a mixture of PPh3 +CH2OCH3Cf (68 g. 0.2 mol) in THF (400 mL), was added n-BuLi (2.5 M, 80 mL. 0.2 mol) dropwise at 0 °C for 30 min. A solution of B-10 (20.0 g, 0.08 mol) in THF ( 100 mL) was added to the PPh3 +CH2OCH Cl" solution at the same temperature. The mixture was slow ly warmed to RT and stirred for 1 h. The solution was quenched with sat. aq. NH4CI and extracted with EtOAc (3 x 400 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine, dried over with Mg2SC>4 and concentrated. The residue was purified by silica gel chromatography (PE) to give B-11 as a colorless oil ( 18 g. 81 %); Ή NMR (400 MHz, CDC ): δ 7.39 (s, 1 H), 7.34 (s, 1 H). 7.24-7.23 (m, 1 H), 7.23- 7.21 (m, 3H), 7.21 -7.20 (m, 2H), 7.06-7.05 (m, 1 H), 6.48 (m, 1 H), 3.66 (s, 3 H).
[0176] A solution of B-l 1 (1 8.0 g, 64.5 mmol) in 1 ,4-dioxane (50 mL) was added HCIO4 (70% aq; 30 mL). The mixture was stirred for 30 min at 90 °C. cooled to RT, and then slow ly poured into a solution of sat. NaHCC^ (300 mL; final pH ~7). The mixture was extracted with EtOAc (3 x 400 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine, dried over with Mg2S04 and concentrated. The solvent was removed to give B-l 2 ( 15 g). which was used in the next step without further purification.
[0177] A mixture of B-12 (15.0 g. 56.8 mmol) and potassium carbonate (25.3 g, 184 mmol) in nitromethane (60 mL) was stirred for 30 min at 25 °C. The mixture was filtered and the filtration was concentrated under reduced pressure. To the residue was added EtOAc (200 mL) and water ( 100 mL). The separated organic phase was washed with brine (2 x 50 mL), dried and concentrated. The residue was purified by silica column chromatography (PE:EtOAc =10: 1) to give B-13 as a colorless oil ( 12 g. 67%). Ή NMR (400 MHz, CDCI3): δ 7.37 (s, 1H), 7.31 - 7.25 (m, 6H), 7.19 (d, J=7.1 Hz. 1H), 5.10 - 5.01 (m, 1H), 4.39 (d, J=5.5 Hz, 2H), 3.96 (d, J=8.6 Hz, 1H), 2.77 (d, J=4.6 Hz, 1H).
[0178] A mixture of B-13 (4.0 g, 12.3 mmol) and Raney nickel (200 mg) in MeOI I (40 mL) was rapidly stirred at RT under a hydrogen atmosphere (45 psi) for 2 h. The mixture was filtered through a pad of cclite, and the filtrate was concentrated to give B-14 as a yellow oil (3.0 g, 83%). LCMS: m/z = 296 [M+H]+
[0179] A solution of B-14 (2.96 g, 10 mmol) in ethyl formate (30 mL) was heated to reflux for 3 h. The mixture was concentrated to give B-15 as a yellow oil (3 g, 93%) that was used in the next step without further purification. LCMS: m/z = 324 [M+H]+.
[0180] To a solution of B-15 (3.2 g, 1 .0 mmol) in THF (20 mL) under N2 atmosphere at 0 °C, was added a solution of BH3 (1 M THF solution, 5 mL) dropw se. The mixture was stirring for 10 min at the same temperature, warmed to RT, and then heated at reflux for 4 h. After complete conversion (as determined by TLC), the mixture was cooled in an ice-water bath, and quenched by adding MeOH (5 mL). Lhe solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in EtOAc, washed with sat. NaHCO^, water, and brine, and dried. The mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure to give amino alcohol AA2 (2 g, 64%). LCMS: m/z = 310 [M+I I]+.
[0181 ] 3-(methylamino)-l -phcnyl- l
Figure imgf000077_0001
was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 5 starting with step 2 and using phenyl(m-tolyl)methanone.
[0182] 3-(ethy lamino)-l -phenyl- l -(m-tolyl)propan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 5 starting with step 2 and using acetic anhydride and LAH.
[0183] 3-(isopropylamino)-l -phenyl-l -(m-tolyl)propan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 5 starting with step 2 and using acetone and NaBH4.
[0184] l , l-bis(4-fluorophenyl)-3-(methylamino)propan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 5 starting with step 2 and using bis(4- fluorophenyl )methanone .
[0185] l , l-bis(3-chloiOphenyi)-3-(isopi pyiamino)piOpan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 5 starting with step 2 and using acetone and sodium borohydride.
EXAMPLE 6 - Route 1
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol (AA3)
Figure imgf000077_0002
B-16 B-17 B-18 AA3
[0186] Glycine methyl ester hydrochloride (50.0 g, 0.398 mol, 1 eq.) was added to a 1L flask containing w7ater (300 mL) and THF (200 niL). Sodium bicarbonate (37.8 g, 0.438 mol) was added portionwise. followed by di-fcrt-butyl dicarbonate (83.4 g, 0.382 mol). The reaction was stirred for 18h, and then the separated organic phase was concentrated. The mixture was redissolved in EtOAC, washed with brine, dried over Na?S04, and evaporated to give an oily product (72g, 95%). The oily product was dissolved in DMF (500 mL) and cooled to 0 °C. To the mixture was added NaH (60%. 18.3g, 0.457 mol) portionwise. The mixture was then stirred for 30 min and Mel (81.1 g, 0.571 mol) was added at such a rate as to maintain a reaction temperature below 20 °C. The mixture was stirred at T for 48 h. The mixture was poured into ice water ( 1 .5L), extracted with MTBE (300 mL x 2). The combined organics were washed with brine, dried over Na2SC>4, and evaporated. Silica gel chromatography (PE:EtOAc 7: 1 ) gave N-Boc-N-mcthyl glycine methyl ester (21 g, 27%).
[0187] Λ solution of B-16 (10.0 g, 51 .5 mmol) in THF ( 15 mL) was cooled to -10 °C. and then n-BuLi (1 .8 M in hexanes. 30 mL) was added dropwise. The mixture was transferred dropwise to a solution of N-Boc-N-methyl glycine methyl ester (5.75 g, 28.3 mmol) in THF (20 mL) while maintaining the temperature below 20 °C. The reaction was stirred for 10 min. and then a sat. NH4CI solution was added. The organic layer was separated, dried over Na2SC»4 and concentrated. Silica gel chromatography (PE:EA 10: 1 ) afforded B-17 (5g, 66%) as a yellow oil.
10188] Dry hydrogen chloride gas was bubbled into a solution of B-17 (5.0 g, 13.7 mmol) in ethyl acetate (50 mL). The mixture was concentrated to give B-18 (3.3g, 80%) as a white solid.
[0189] To a mixture of B-18 (4.3g, 14.2 mmol) in MeOH (45 mL) was added NaBH4 (1.6 g, 42.9 mmol) portionwise. The mixture was stirred for 1 h. A solution of sat. NH4CI was added, and the mixture was extracted with EtOAc (100 mL x 2). The combined organic layer was washed with brine, dried over Na?S04, and concentrated to give amino alcohol AA3 (1 .9 g 50.7%) as a white solid; Ή NMR (400M Hz, CDC13) δ (ppm) 7.1 1 - 7.27(m, 8H), 4.43(m, 1 H), 3.84(m, 1 H), 4.50(m, 2H), 4.29(m, 2H), 2.48(m, 2H), 2.34(s, 3H).
EXAMPLE 6 - Route 2
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol (AA3(HC1))
Figure imgf000078_0001
B-18(2) AA3(HCI)
[0190] Compound B-16 (20 g; 103 mmol; 2eq) was dissolved in dry7 THF (300 mL) under Ντ atmosphere. The mixture was chilled at 0 °C and n-BuLi (1.6 M, 103 mmol; 2eq) was added dropwise. The mixture turned red and was stirred 30 min at 0 °C. N-Boc sarcosine ( 1 eq.; 51.5 mmol; 10.4 g), dissolved in dry THF (30 mL), was added dropwise. After 20 mins. the reaction was quenched using sat. NH4CI solution and extracted into EtOAc (2x). The organic phase was purified by silica gel chromatography (100:0 to 85: 15, Cy:EtOAc) to give B-17 (16 g).
[0191 ] To a solution of B-17 (16g; 44.8mmol) dissolved in MeOH (200 mL) was added NaBH4 (4 eq.; 6.6 g), portionwise, over 2 h. The reaction was partitioned between sat. NH4CI solution and EtOAc. The organic solvent was dried over Na2S04 and concentrated to give B-18(2) (16g).
[0192] Compound B-18(2) ( 16g) was dissolved in 4M HCl ( 160 mL) in dioxane. The mixture was stirred 1 h, and a heavy precipitation was formed. The mixture was diluted with Et20 (200 mL) and then filtered to give AA3(HC1) (12g) as a white powder.
[0193] 2-(benzylamino)-l -(10, l l -dihydro-5H-dibenzo[a,d] [7]annulen-5- yl)ethanol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 6 (Route 2) and using methyl [benzyi(tert-butoxycarbonyl)amino]acetate.
[0194] 1 -( 10, 1 l-dihydro-5H-dibenzo[a,d] [7]annulen-5-yi)-2-(ethylamino)ethanol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 6 (Route 2) and using methyl [(tert-butoxycarbonyi)(ethyi)amino]acetate.
[0195] 1 -(10, 1 l-dihydro-5H-dibenzo[a,d] [7]annulen-5-yl)-2- (isopropylamino)ethanol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 6 (Route 2) and using methyl 2- { [(tert-butoxy)carbonyl](propan-2- yl)amino}acetate.
[0196] 1 -(1 ,9-difluoro- l 0, 1 1 -dihydro-5H-dibenzoLa,d][7]annulen-5-yl)-2- (isopropylamino)ethanol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 6 (Route 2) and using methyl 2- { [(tert-butoxy)carbonyl](propan-2- yl)ami no { acetate.
[0197] 3-(methy lamino)-l -phenyl-1 -(pyridin-2-yl)propan-2-ol di hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 6 (Route 2) and using 2- benzylpyiidine.
Figure imgf000080_0001
A-15
[0198] Compound A-15 was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 6 (Route 2) and using (R)-ethyl 2-(5-(benzyloxy)-4-oxo-N-( l .l -trifluoropropan^- y -l -^-^rimethylsily ethoxy^methy -l ^-d^
Figure imgf000080_0002
[0199] 1 -(2-hydroxy-3 -(isopropylamino)- 1 -phenylpropyl)- 1 H-pyrazole-3 - carbonitrile hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 6 (Route 2) starting with step 2 and using tert-butyl (3-(3-cyano- l H-pyrazol- l -yl)-2-oxo-3- phenylpropyl)(isopropyl)carbamate.
Figure imgf000080_0003
[0200] 1 -(3-(but- 1 -yn- 1 -yl)-
Figure imgf000080_0004
1 -pheny lpropan-2- ol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 6 (Route 2) starting with step 2 and using tert-butyl (2-hydroxy-3-(3-iodo-l H-pyrazol-l -yl)-3- phenylpropyl)(methyl)carbamate, followed by acetylene coupling prior to step 3. EXAMPLE 7
Synthesis of Compound of Formula (I) - Route 1
Figure imgf000081_0001
Formula (I) an optionally substituted
Figure imgf000081_0002
alkyl)
[0201 ] A mixture of compound H (1 .00 g, 2.67 mmol), HATU (1 .21 g. 3.20 mmol) and DIEA (516 mg, 4.00 mmol) in DCM (20 mL) was stirred at RT for 30 min. The 1.2-amino-alcohol (for example, compound A-6, 584 mg, 2.42 mmol) was added, and the mixture was stirred for 1 h. The reaction was quenched with I M HCl solution. The organic layer was washed with saturated NaHCO; solution and brine. The organic layer was dried and concentrated to give compound A-7 ( 1.0 g, 60%) as an oil. ESTMS: m/z = 600.1 [M +H]+.
10202] To a solution of A-7 (400 mg, 0.66 mmol) in DCM ( 10 mL) was added TEA (198 mg, 1.98 mmol) and MsCl (752 mg, 6.6 mmol) at 0 °C. After 30 min, LCMS showed complete conversion to A-8. The mixture was washed with IM HCl solution, saturated NaHCO^ solution and brine. The organic layer was dried and concentrated to give A-9 (400 mg, 90%) as an oil. ESl-MS: m/z = 678.1 [M +H]+.
[0203] To a solution of A-9 (400 mg, 0.59 mmol) in MeOH (10 mL), was added 10% Pd/C (200 mg). The mixture was stirred at RT for 2 h under I I2 atmosphere (I I2 balloon). After complete conversion (as shown by LCMS). the mixture was filtered through a pad of celite and rinsed with 10% MeOH/CH2Cl2. The filtrate was concentrated to give the crude product as a pale brown solid (300 mg, 86 %), which was used in the next step without further purification. ESI-MS: m/z = 588.2 [M +H] \
[0204] To a solution of the crude product (300 mg, 0.51 mmol) in DCM (5 mL) was added trifluoroacetic acid (2 mL) dropwise at 0 °C. and then stirred at 0 °C overnight. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure to give A-9 as a brown solid. (200 mg, 85 %). ESI-MS: m/z = 458.2 [M +H]+.
[0205] To a solution of A-9 (200 mg, 0.43 mmol) in DMF (5 mL) was added K2C03 ( 182 mg. 1 .31 mmol). The mixture was stirred at RT until the reaction was complete as indicated by LCMS (approx. 1 h). The reaction solution was filtered and directly purified by RP-HPLC (0.1 % formic acid/ACN) to give Formula (I). Further purification by chiral column chromatography, if needed, (either normal phase using Chiralpak AS-H 5 um chiral packing or SFC conditions using ChiralTech OD-H 3-5 um chiral packing) enables the separation and isolation of enantiomerically pure stereoisomers of Formula (IA).
Figure imgf000082_0001
[0206] Compound 1 -A was obtained following the procedure for Formula (IA) using AA6 and compound H. Compound 1 -A was obtained as a white solid (50 mg, 32 %). ESI-MS: m/z = 362 [M+FF]+.
EXAMPLE 8
Synthesis of Compound of Formula (I) - Route 2
alkyl),
Figure imgf000083_0001
alkyl) or
Formula (I) an optionally substituted heterocycly C^e alkyl)
[0207] Compound A-7 was obtained following the procedure as described herein in Example 7.
[0208] A round bottom flask was charged with A-7, polymer supported tri- phenylphosphine (2.75 equiv., 100-200 mesh, 3.2 mniol/g loading) and dry N-methyl-2- pyrrolidinone (NMP, 6.5 mL). The flask was placed in an 85 "C oil bath and diisopropyl azodicarboxylate (DIAD, 2.5 eq.) was added via syringe in approximately 4 equal portions at 30 minute intervals. The reaction was monitored by LCMS. The reaction was heated for a total of 2.5 h. then cooled to ambient temperature and diluted with 1 % MeOH/EtOAc (5 mL) and filtered through a plug of celite. The resin was rinsed with 1 % MeOH/EtOAc (30 mL). The filtrate was shaken with an equal volume of 2% NH4CI (aq) in a separately funnel. The EtOAc phase was collected, and the aqueous phase was further extracted with EtOAc (3 x 20 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine, dried (MgS04). filtered and concentrated. The crude product was purified by Reverse Phase chromatography to provide Formula (I) following concentration and lyophylization (HPLC conditions: A: LLO B: Acetonitrile; Phenomenex HydroRP C 18 column 250 x 30 cm; 254 nJVl detection; flow rate: 24mL/min; gradient: start at 5 %B and increase from 5-75 %B over 20 min. then 75-95 %B over 2 min, then hold at 95 %B for 5 min; RT = ~21 min).
Figure imgf000084_0001
[0209] Compound 1 was obtained following the procedure for Formula (l)- oute 2 of Example 8 using 4-hydroxy-N-(2-hydroxy-4,4-diphenylbutyl)-N-methyl-5-oxo-2,5- dihydiOpyridazine-3-carboxamide (222 mg, 0.59 mmol) and polymer-Ph3P (505 mg). Compound 1 was obtained as a light brown powder (14 mg, 6.6 %). MS m/z = 362 [M+H]+, 360 [M-H]~.
EXAM LE 9
Synthesis of Compound 10
Figure imgf000084_0002
[0210] A mixture of compound H (2.03 g. 5.4 mmol). HATU (2.24 g. 5.8 mmol) and TEA (0.73 g, 7.35 mmol) in DCM (20 mL) was stirred for 0.5 h at 25 °C. Compound AA1 (1.5 g, 4.9 mmol) was added to the mixture in a single portion. After 1 h, the mixture was washed with 1 M HC1 solution ( 10 mL x 3), sat. NaHCOs ( 10 mL x 3), and brine (5 mL x 2). The separated organic layer was dried and concentrated to give A-9 as a brown solid (2 g, 62%). LCMS: m/z = 664 [M+I I]+.
[0211 ] A solution of A-9 (500 mg, 0.75 mmol) in TFA (5 mL) was heated to 90 °C for 2 h. The solvent was removed in vacuum, and the product was purified by prep- RPHPLC (C] 8, 0.1 % formic acid/A CN) to give compound 10 as a pair of partially separable isomers: (Rt = 0.554 min, m/z = 426. 10 mg; Rt = 0.630 min. m/z = 426. 10 mg; 6%). LCMS: m/z = 426 | \ l l l | .
EXAMPLE 10
Synthesis of Compounds 6 and 11
Figure imgf000085_0001
[0212] Compound A-10 was prepared as described herein in Example 7 by substituting compound H with compound L, and substituting HATU in DCM with HBTU in DMF. [0213] To a -78 °C solution of oxalyl chloride (0.37 mL, 4.26 mmol) in dry DCM (12 mL) was added, dropwise, a solution of DMSO (0.31 mL, 4.26 mmol) in DCM (2 mL). The mixture was stirred for 5 min. A solution of A-10 (1 .78 g, 2.66 mmol) in DCM ( 10 mL) was added, dropwise. over ~5 min. followed by a DCM rinse (2 mL) at -78 °C. The mixture was stirred at -78 °C for 7 min. and then a solution of Et3N ( 1 .1 1 mL, 8 mmol) in DCM (3 mL) was added, dropwise. The orange solution was stirred at -78 °C for 5 min, and then allowed to warm to RT. The mixture was stirred at RT for 30 min. Water (50 mL) and DCM (50 mL) was added, and the layers were separated. The aqueous portion was extracted with DCM (25 mL) and the combined DCM portion was washed with brine, dried over sodium sulfate, and concentrated. Silica gel chromatography (1 -5% MeOH in DCM) yielded A-ll (1.63 g, 92%) as a pale yellow oil.
10214] A solution of A-ll (130 mg, 0.19 mmol) in DCM (1 mL) was treated with TFA (1 mL), and the solution was stirred at RT for 2.5 h. The reaction was monitored by LCMS and shows both SEM groups were cleaved. The solution was concentrated under reduced pressure to give A-12, which was used without further purification.
[0215] To a solution of A-12 in 1 ,4-dioxane (1 mL), was added sulfuric acid (37gm, 0.38 mmol). The mixture was heated at 1 10 °C for 24 h. The reaction was cooled to RT. and water (2 mL) was added, dropwise, with stirring. The mixture was filtered and yielded compound 11 as a pale yellow solid (59 mg, 81 %). MS: m/z = 388 [M+HJ 1 .
[0216] To a solution of compound 11 (50 mg, 0.13 mmol) in MeOH (6 mL) and acetic acid (0.6 mL). was added PtO? (20 mg) in one portion. The mixture was stirred at RT under a LL atmosphere at 50 psi for 2 h. The mixture was filtered through a pad of celite, and the filtrate was concentrated purified by prep-RP-HPLC to give compound 6 as a white solid (13 mg. 26%). MS: m/z = 390 [M+H]+.
EXAMPLE 11
Synthesis of Compound 65-A
Figure imgf000087_0001
7-A 65-A
[0217] To a solution of 7-A (125 mg, 0.32 mmol) in CH2C12 (2 mL) was added diisopropyl ethyl amine (0.078 ml, 0.45 mmol), followed by isobutryl chloride (0.042 mL. 0.4 mmol). The mixture was stirred 2 h at RT, diluted with CH2Cl2 (30 mL), and washed with dilute NaHCO solution. The DCM layer was washed with brine, dried over sodium sulfate, and concentrated to give a pale, orange oil. A small volume of DCM (2.5 mL) was added, followed by the addition of hexane until just cloudy. A white solid crystallized after standing. Filtration gave compound 65-A as a white solid (85%). MS: m/z = 458 [M+H]+.
[0218| Compound 58-A was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 1 1 and using 41-A and acetyl chloride. MS: m/z = 463 [M+H]+.
[0219] Compound 66-A was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 1 1 and using 6-A and acetyl chloride. MS: m/z = 432 [M+H]+.
[0220] Compound 67-A was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 1 1 and using 4-A. MS: m/z = 480 [M+H]+.
[0221 ] Compound 69-A was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 1 1 and using 6-A. MS: m/z = 460 [M+I I]+.
[0222] Compound 70-A was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 1 1 and using 41-A. MS: m/z = 496 [M+H]+.
[0223] Compound 72-A was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 1 1 and using 21 -A. MS: m/z = 482 [M+H]+.
[0224] Compound 114-A was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 1 1 and using 51 , followed by chiral SFC separation. MS: m/z = 522 [M+H]+. EXAMPLE 12
Synthesis of Compound 96-A
Figure imgf000088_0001
96-A
[0225] To a solution of N-Boc- valine ( 10 g, 46.08 mmol) in EtOH (70 mL) was added Cs2C03 (14.97 g, 46.06 mmol) in a solution of LLO (30 mL). The mixture was stirred at RT for 30 mins. co-evaporated w ith toluene to dryness, re-dissolved in DMF (1 00 mL) and cooled in an ice bath. Chloroiodomethane (81.1 g, 460.8 mmol) was added dropwise at 0 °C. The mixture was stirred at RT in the dark (tin foil) for 12 h. The mixture was treated with H2O (200 mL), extracted with EtOAc (3 x 100 mL). The combined organic layers were dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica gel eluted with PE:EA= 100: 1 to 60: 1 to give (S)-chloromethyl 2- ((tert-butoxycarbonyl)amino)-3 -methylbutanoate (37%).
[0226] To a solution of (S)-chloromethyl 2-((tert-butoxycarbonyl)amino)-3- methylbutanoate (4.53 g, 17 mmol) in acetone (50 mL) was added Nal (7.67 g, 51 mmol). The mixture was heated to reflux for 12 h. The solution was diluted with LLO ( 100 mL) and extracted with EtOAc (3 x 50 mL). The combined organic layers were dried over Na2S04. filtered and concentrated. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica gel, eluted with PE:EA = 100: 1 to 50: 1 , to give (S)-iodomethyl 2-((tert- butoxycarbonyl)amino)-3-methylbutanoate (3 g, 49%) as a white solid. Ή NMR (400 MHz, CDC13): δ ppm 6.06-6.05-7.30 (d. J=2.2. 1 H). 5.86-5.85 (d. J=2.0. 1 Η),4.97-4.95 (d. J=4.0. 1H). 4.25-4.22 (m, 1 H), 2.20-2.1 8 (m. 1 H). 1 .46 (s, 9H). 1 .01 -1 .00 (d, J=3.6. 3H), 0.94-0.93 (d. J=3.4, 3H).
[0227] To a solution of 6-A (300 mg, 0.77 mmol) in acetone (30 mL) was added K2CO3 (212.85 mg, 1.542 mmol) and (S)-iodomethyl 2-((tert-butoxycarbonyl)amino)-3- methylbutanoate (0.82 g, 2.31 mmol) at RT under N2. The mixture was stirred at the same temperature for 12 h. The reaction was quenched with H2O and extracted with EtOAc. The combined organic phases were dried over Na^SO.!, filtered and concentrated. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica gel eluted with PE:EA= 5 : 1 to 1 : 1 to give 6-B (55%) as a white solid. +ES1-MS: m/z 619.3 [M+EL]+.
[02281 To a solution of 6-B (260 mg. 0.42 mmol) in DCM (20 mL) at 0°C was added to HCl/Et20 (20 mL, 2N) dropwise. The mixture was stirred at 0 °C for 1 h and slowly warmed to RT. The mixture was stirred for 1 1 h. The solution was concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude product was washed with Et?0 (20 mL), and filtered to give compound 96-A (86%) as a beige solid. MS: m/z = 519 [M+H]+.
EXAMPLE 13
Synthesis of Compound 85-A
Figure imgf000089_0001
[0229] To a solution of 21 -A (30 mg, 0.073 mol) in dry DMT (3 mL) was added K2CO3 (51 mg. 0.37 mol) and ethyl iodide (57 mg, 0.37 mol). The mixture was stirred at RT for 12 h. The mixture was diluted with water (10 mL) and dichloromethane (15 mL). The organic layer was separated, washed with water and brine, and dried of Na2SC>4. Concentration of the mixture gave compound 85-A (29 mg) as a light brown solid. MS: m/z = 440 [M+I I]
EXAMPLE 14
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol (AA4)
Figure imgf000090_0001
AA4
[0230] To a solution of 3-fluoro-2-methylbenzoic acid ( 1 g; 6.49 mmol) in dry THF ( 1 5 mL) at -60 °C, s-BuTi in cyclohexane (2.5 eq.; 1 .4M solution; 12ml) was added. The deep red mixture was stirred for 1 h at -50/-60 °C. To the mixture was added dropwise a cooled (-40 °C) solution of 2-fluorobenzyl chloride (1 .13 g; 1 .2 eq.) in THF (10 mL). The mixture was stirred at -40 °C. After 30 mins. an UPLC check showed almost complete conversion to the desired compound: after 1 h. The reaction was quenched with 2M NaOH (7 mL) and concentrated in vacuo. The aqueous phase was washed with cyclohexane (2x). The organics were discarded, and the aqueous phase was acidified with 37% HC1. The mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (2x). The organic phase was washed with brine, dried over Na?S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give B-19 ( 1.10 g), which was used in the next step without further purification.
[0231] Oxalyl chloride (1.1 eq.; 0.39 mL) and DMF (3 drops) were added at T to a solution of B-19 (1.1 g; 4.19 mmol; 1 eq. ) in DCM dry (35 mL). The mixture was stirred at RT. After 3 h, the mixture was diluted with DCM (30 mL) and A1C1 ( 1.5 eq.; 0.84 g) was added. After 12 h, an HPLC showed almost complete conversion to the desired compound. After 2 h, ice and water were added. The mixture was extracted with DCM (2x). The organic phase was washed with water, a I N aqueous NaOI I solution and water. The organic phase was dried over Na7S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give the crude (0.8 g). The crude was purified by flash chromatography (Biotage KP-Sil l OOg SNAP cartridge, gradient cyclohexane:EA from 100:0 to 95:5 in 10CV, fraction size 42 mL) to give B-20 (0.52 g) as a yellow solid.
[0232] To a well-stirred solution of TFA (76 eq.; 12.46 mL) at 0 °C, was added, dropwise, a solution of B-20 (0.52 g; 2.12 mmol) in DCM (8 mL). NaBH4 was added portionwise (12 eq.; 962 mg; added in 4 portions). The ice-bath was removed, and the mixture was stirred overnight at RT. HPLC showed complete conversion to B-21. The mixture was poured into an ice-water, basified with solid NaOH, and extracted with DCM (2x). The organic phase was washed with water and dried over N 2S04. The solvent was removed under vacuum. The crude material was purified by flash chromatography (Biotage KP-Sil 50g SNAP cartridge, gradient cyclohexane:EA from 99: 1 to 90: 10 in 10CV, fraction size 9 mL) gave B-21 as a white solid (0.40 g).
[0233] Following Example 6 (route 2), B-21 was converted to amino alcohol
AA4.
[0234] 1 -(2,8-dichloro- 10, 1 1 -dihydro-5H-dibenzo[a,d] [7]annulen-5-yl)-2- (methylamino)ethanol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 14 and using 4-chloro-2-mcthylbenzoic acid and 3-chlorobcnzylbi midc.
[0235] 1 -( 1 ,8-difluoro- 10.1 1 -dihydro-5H-dibcnzo[a.dJ [7]annulen-5-yl)-2- (methylamino)ethanol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 14 and using 4-fluoro-2-methylbenzoic acid and 2-fluorobenzylbromide.
[0236] 1 -(1.8-difluoro-l 0, 1 1 -dihydro-5H-dibenzo[a.d] [7]annulen-5-yl)-2- (methylamino)ethanol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 14 and using 4-fluoro-2-methylbenzoic acid and 2-fluorobenzyl bromide. EXAMPLE 15
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol (AA9)
Figure imgf000092_0001
AA9
[0237| Nitric acid ( 1 10 mL) was added dropwise at 0 °C to B-22 ( 10 g) over 2 h. The mixture was stirred at 0 °C for 2 h and then slowly poured into chilled water (700 mL). The precipitate obtained was filtered to give a pale yellow7 solid (15.6 g). The solid was stirred in boiling in EtOH (2 x 40 mL) and filtered to give B-23 ( 12 g) as a pale yellow solid containing a mixture of 1 ,7- and 3,7-dinitro products that was used in the next step without further purification.
[0238] Pd/C 10% (2.5 g) was added to a suspension of B-23 (12 g) in EtOH (500 mL). The mixture was stirred under hydrogen ( 1 atm) at RT. After 3.5 h. the mixture was filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by silica gel flash chromatography (gradient CH2Cl2:MeOH from 100:0 to 90: 10) to give B-24 (600 mg. as the first eluting spot) and B-25 (4.76 g. as second eluting spot). B-24 - Ή NMR (400 MHz. CDC13) δ ppm 2.84-2.99 (m. 2 H) 3.06-3.16 (m, 2 H) 6.76 (dd. .1=8.03. 2.51 Hz. 1 H) 6.87 (dd, .1=7.91 , 1 .13 Hz, 1 H) 6.96-7.06 (m, 2 H) 7.15 (t, .1=7.78 Hz, 1 IT) 7.36 - 7.47 (m, 1 H). B-25 - Ή NMR (400 MHz, CDC13) δ ppm 3.08 (s, 4 H) 6.80 (dd, .1=8.16, 2.64 Hz, 2 H) 7.04 (d, J=8.28 I Iz, 2 1 1) 7.27 - 7.38 (m. 2 11).
[0239] Compound B-25 (830 mg) was added to a suspension of CuCL (1 .87 g) and tert-butyl nitrite ( 1.25 mL) in dry CH3CN (21 mL) at 0 °C. The mixture was allowed to warm up at RT for 2.5 h, and then heated at 50 °C. After 21 h, C11CI2 and tert-butyl nitrite (same quantities as above) were added, and the mixture was heated again. After 25 h, a third addition of the same quantities of CuCL and tert-butyl nitrite was made. After 28 h, the mixture was diluted with CH2Cl2and filtered on a celite pad. The organic phase was washed with water, 2N aqueous HCI solution, sat. aqueous NaHC03 and brine. The organic layer was dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The crude material was purified by silica gel flash chromatography (cyclohexane:EA from 98:2 to 80:20) to give B-26 (966 mg) as a pale yellow solid.
[0240] To stirred, 0 °C TFA (1 1 mL) solution was added, dropwise, a solution of B-26 (517 mg) in dry CH2C12 (6.5 mL), followed by the portionwise addition of NaBH4 (849 mg). The ice-bath was removed, and the mixture was stirred overnight at RT. The mixture was poured into ice, basified with 2N aqueous NaOH (100 mL) and extracted with diethyl ether (3x). The organic phase was washed with water and dried over Na SC^. The solvent was removed under vacuum. The crude material (447 mg) was purified by silica gel Hash chromatography (gradient cyclohexane:EA from 98:2 to 90: 10) to give B-27 (366 mg) as a white solid.
[0241 ] Following Example 6 (route 2), B-27 was converted to amino alcohol
AA9.
Figure imgf000093_0001
AA10
[0242] Amino alcohol AA10 was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 15 and using HBF4/NaNC>2.
Figure imgf000094_0001
AA11
[0243] Amino alcohol AAll was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 15 and using HBF NaNOi.
EXAMPLE 16
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol (AAgl)
Figure imgf000094_0002
AAg1 [0244] To a solution of N, O-dimethylhydroxylamine hydrochloride (1 38 g, 1 .42 mol) in DCM (1 .5 L) was added Et3N (383 g, 3.78 mol) at RT. To the stirred mixture, G-l (150 g, 946 mmol) was added dropwise at 0 "C under atmosphere. The solution was stirred at the same temperature for 1 h, and then slowly warmed to RT for 10 h. The mixture was added to water (~ l L) and extracted with EtOAc (2 x 500 niL). The combined organic phases were dried with Na2S04. filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash column chromatography (eluent: PE) to give G-2 as a white solid (150 g. yield: 86.5%). Ή NMR (400 MHz. CDC13): δ 7.49-7.43 (1 H, m). 7.41 -7.32 (2 H. m), 7.18-7.10 (1 H, m), 3.54 (3 H. s), 3.34 (3 H, s).
[0245] To a solution of G-3 (133 g. 764 mmol) in THP ( 1 L) at -78 °C under N2 atmosphere, was added n-BuLi (305 mL, 764 mmol) dropwise over 1 h. The solution was treated with a solution of G-2 ( 100 g. 546 mmol) in THF. After addition, the mixture was slowly warmed to RT and stirred for 16 h. The solution was quenched with water (1 L) and extracted with EtOAc (3 x 400 mL). The combined organic layers were dried over with Na?S04, filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by silica gel column chromatography (PE:EtOAc = 50: 1 ) to provide G-4 as a white solid ( 104 g, yield: 87.3 %).
[0246] To a solution of EtPPh Br (442 g, 1.19 mol) in THF (1.0 L) at 0 °C under N2, was added n-BuLi (476 mL, 1.19 mol) dropwise over 1 h. The mixture was slowly warmed and a solution of G-4 (104 g, 476 mmol) in THF was added dropwise over 1 h. The reaction was quenched with water (1 .0 L) and extracted with EtOAc (3 x 400 mL). The combined organic layers were dried over with Na2S04. filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by silica gel column chromatography (PE:EtOAc = 100: 1 ) to afford G-5 as a colorless oil (90 g, yield: 82 %).
[0247] To a solution of G-5 (30 g. 130 mmol) in DCM (2.0 L) was added NaHCOi (23 g, 273 mmol). The stirred mixture was cooled to 0 °C and treated with m- CPBA (56.2 g, 325 mmol) portionwise. After addition, the mixture was stirred at the same temperature for 3 h. The reaction was quenched with sat. aq. Na^S^C^ and extracted w ith DCM (3 x 500 mL). The combined organic layers were dried over with NaiSC^, filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by silica gel column chromatography (PE:EtOAc =100: 1) to provide G-6 as a yellow oil ( 13 g, 40.5 %). Ή NMR (CDC13): δ 7.26-7.24 (m, 11 1), 7.17-7.15 (m, 11 1), 7.08-6.99(m, 611), 3.48-3.43 (m, 1 1 1), 1 .25- 1 .17 (m, 31 1).
[0248] To a solution of G-6 (20 g, 81 .2 mmol) in ΤΗΓ (300 niL) was added BF3 Et20 ( 100 mL) at RT. The mixture was stirred at the same temperature for 2 h. After complete conversion, the reaction was quenched with sat. aq. NaHC03 and extracted with EtOAc (3 x 100 mL). The combined organic layers were dried over with Na2S04, filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by silica gel column chromatography (PE:EtOAc =10: 1 ) to afford G-7 as a yellow oil (1 5 g, yield: 75%). Ή NMR (CDC13): 5 7.35-7.29 (m. 2H), 7.02-7.96 (m, 6H), 5.1 0 (s. 1 H), 2.27 (s, 3H).
[0249] To a solution of G-7 (15 g, 60.9 mmol) in AcOH (120 mL) at 60 °C. was added Br2 (9.73 g, 60.9 mmol) dropwise under N2 atmosphere. The mixture was stirred at 60 °C for 2 h (indicated by TLC, PE: EtOAc= 20: 1). The mixture was slowly poured into ice- water (200 mL). The mixture was extracted with EA (3 x 50 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with NaHC(¾ brine, dried over with Na2S04 and filtered. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure to give crude G-8 (25 g). which was used in the next step without further purification.
[0250] To a solution of crude G-8 (50 g) in THF (300 mL) at 0 °C under N2 atmosphere, was added NaBH4 (20 g, 529 mmol) portionwise. The mixture was stirred at RT for 3 h. The reaction was quenched with H20 (500 mL). The solution was extracted with EtOAc (3 x 300 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried with NaS04, filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash column chromatography to give G-9 as a colorless oil (36 g, yield: 71 .6 %). Ή NMR (CDC13): δ 7.36-7.29 (m, 2H). 7.19-7.1 1 (m, 3H), 7.07-6.95 (m, 3H),4.53-4.48 (m, 1 H),4.19-4.17 (m. 1 H), 3.57-3.54 (m. 1H). 3.37-3.33 (m, 1 H).
[0251] To a solution of G-9 (36 g, 1 10.72 mmol) in MeOH (200 mL) was added K2C03 (39.54 g, 286.1 mmol) at RT. The mixture was stirred at the same temperature for 1 h (indicated by TLC, PE:EtOAc = 10: 1). The mixture was filtered, and the filtrate cake was washed with DCM. The combined filtrates were concentrated in vacuum. The residue was purified by flash column chromatography (PE:EtOAc =100: 1) to give G-10 as a colorless oil (19 g, yield: 70.1 %). Ή NMR (CDClj): δ 7.29-7.27 (m, 2H), 7.06-6.92 (m, 6H), 3.84-3.82 (d, J = 6.8, 1 H), 3.78-3.88 (m, 1 H), 2.88-2.85 (t, J = 4.4, 1 H), 2.51 -2.49 (m, 1 H).
[0252] Compound G-10 (9.5 g, 38 mmol) was added into a solution of isopropylaminerEtOH ( 100 niL, v:v, 9: 1 ). The mixture was stirred at RT overnight (indicated by TLC, PE:EtOAc = 10: 1 ). The mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure to afford amino alcohol AAgl as an oil (10 g. yield: 86%).
[0253] l , l -bis(3-fluorophenyl)-3-(propylamino)propan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using n-propylamine.
[0254] l , l-bis(3-fluorophenyl)-3-(butylylamino)propan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using n-butylamine.
[0255] 3-((2-(benzyloxy)ethyl)amino)- 1 , 1 -bis(3-fluorophenyl)propan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 2- (benzyloxy)ethanamine.
[0256] l , l-bis(3-fluorophenyl)-3-(isobutylamino)pi pan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 2-methylpropan- l -amine.
[0257] l -(3-chlorophenyl)-3-(isopropylamino)- l-phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3-chlorophenyl)(phenyl)methanone (prepared following step one of Example 5 using 3-chlorobenzoyl chloride and phenylboronic acid).
[0258] l -(3-chlorophenyl)-3-(methylamino)-l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3-chloropheny l)(phenyl)methanone and methy lamine.
[0259] l -(3-chlorophenyl)-3-(ethylamino)-l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3-chlorophenyl)(phenyl)methanone and ethyiamine.
[0260] l -(3-methoxyphenyl)-3-(methylamino)-l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3- methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methanone (prepared following step 1 of Example 5 using 3- methoxybenzoyl chloride and phenylboronic acid) and methylamine. [0261] l -(3-methoxyphenyl)-3-(ethylamino)- l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3-
Figure imgf000098_0001
and ethylamine.
[0262] l -(3-fluorophenyl)-3-(meth\iamino)- l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using (3- fluorophenyl)(phenyl)methanone (prepared following step 1 of Example 5 using 3- fluorobenzoyl chloride and phenylboronic acid) and methylamine.
[0263] 3-(ethylamino)-l -(3-fluorophenyl)-l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using (3- fluorophenyl)(phenyl)methanone and ethylamine.
[0264| 3-(methylamino)-l , l -di-m-tolylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using bis(3-methylphenyl)methanone (prepared follow ing step one of Example 5 using 3-methylbenzoyl chloride and 3-methylphenylboronic acid) and methylamine.
[0265] 3-(isopropylamino)-l, l -di-m-tolylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using bis(3-methylphenyl)methanone and isopropylamine.
[0266] 1 -(3-isopropoxyphenyl)-3-(methylamino)-l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3-isopropoxybenzoic acid and HATU to prepare the corresponding Ν,Ο-dimethyl amide.
[0267] 1 -(3-(cyelopropylmethoxy)phenyl)-3-(methylamino)-l -phenylpropan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3- (cyclopropylmethoxy )benzoic acid and using HATU to prepare the corresponding N.O- dimethyl amide.
[0268] 1 , l-bis(3-chlorophenyl)-3-(isopropylamino)propan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3-chlorobenzoyl chloride and 3- bromochlorobenzene.
[0269] l , l-bis(3-chlorophenyi)-3-(ethylamino)propan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3-chlorobenzoyl chloride and ethylamine. [0270] l ,l -bis(3-chlorophenyl)-3-(propylamino)propan-2-ol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 16 and using 3-chlorobenzoyl chloride and propylamine.
EXAMPLE 17
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol (AAjl)
Figure imgf000099_0001
J-6
J -5
Figure imgf000099_0002
[0271 ] Triphenylphosphine (15.3 g. 58.37 mmol. 1 eq.) was diluted in MeOH (100 mL). 3-chlorobenzylchloride (9.4 g, 58.37 mmol, 1 eq.) diluted in MeOH (50 mL) was added dropwise to the stirred solution. The mixture was heated at reflux for 2 h. The mixture was cooled to 0 °C and 2-formylbenzoic acid (8.7 g, 58.37 mmol, 1 cq.) was added. Sodium methoxide (28% in MeOH; 28.0 g, 145 mmol, 2.5 eq.) was added dropwise at 0 °C. over period of 45 mins. The mixture was stirred for 3 h at 0 °C. The mixture was poured onto a stirred mixture of ice (75 g) and H2O (175 mL). The mixture was filtered, and the filtrate was washed several times with LLO. The combined aqueous phases were washed several times with DCM. The aqueous phase was then acidified and extracted with DCM. The organic phase was concentrated in vacuo to give the crude product that was purified by silica-gel chromatography (340 g, 100% Cychex to 70/30 Cychex/EtOAc in 12cv) to give J-l (5.5 g) as a mixture of cis- and trans- isomers.
[0272] Compound J-l (5.5 g, 21.26 mmol, 1 eq.) was dissolved in a mixture of EA (75 mL), CLLCN (75 mL) and Pd on activated carbon (1.5 g) was added. The mixture was stirred under H2 atmosphere for 2 h at RT. The mixture was filtered, and the solvent was removed in vacuo to give J-2 (5.2 g).
[0273] Intermediate J-2 (5.2 g 19.95 mmol, 1 eq.) was dissolved in DCM ( 150 mL) containing a catalytic amount of DMT, and then oxalyl chloride (2.6 g, 19.95 mmol, 1 eq.) was added dropwise. The mixture was stirred at RT for 1 h under Ar atmosphere. The resulting acid chloride mixture was added to suspension of AICI3 (3.9 g 1 .5eq., 30 mmol) in DCM (50 mL). The mixture was stirred for 4 h at RT. The mixture was poured onto ice. extracted with DCM, washed NaOH and FLO, and dried over Na2S04. The solvent were removed in vacuo to give J-3 (4.7 g. see Martz, K.E.. et. al, J. Med. hem. (2012) 55(17):7862-7874). Ή NMR (400 MHz. CDC13) ppm 3.23 (s. 4 H) 7.25-7.27 (m. 1 H) 7.29 (s, 1 H) 7.32-7.41 (m. 2 H) 7.43-7.52 (m. 1 H) 8.00-8.08 (m, 2 H).
[0274] Following Example 5, steps 2-5, J-3 was converted to J-4.
[0275] A solution of J-4 (2.7 g, 9.38 mmol) in DCM ( 140 mL) was treated with DIPEA (28.08 mmol 4.88 mL) and triphosgene (1.1 1 g, 3.74 mmol). The mixture was stirred at RT for 1 h. The reaction was quenched with sat. NH4CI solution and extracted with EtOAc (2 x 50 mL). Lhe organic phases were dried over Na^SC^ and purified by silica gel column chromatography (Cychex:EtOAc: 80:20 to 50:50) to give J-5 ( 1.7 g). [0276] NaH (28.5 mg, 1 .19 mmol) was added at 0 °C to a solution of J-5 (300 mg, 0.95 mmol) in dry TI IF (8.6 mL). The mixture was stirred at this temperature for 1 5 mins, and then for 30 mins at RT. Mel (65.2 μΐ) was added, and the mixture was stirred at RT. After 1 h, an additional amount of NaH (0.3 eq.) and Mel (0.3 eq.) was added. The mixture was stirred overnight at RT. A sat. aq. NH4CI solution was added, and the mixture was extracted with DCM (2x). The organic phase was washed with brine, dried over Na2S04, filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give J-6 (260 mg) as a colorless oil, which was used without further purification.
[0277] Compound J-6. (260 mg; 0.79 mmol) was dissolved in 1 : 1 dioxane:water (36 mL) and LiOH (13.8 mL, 1.56 M) was added. The mixture was heated at 60 °C for 12 h. The organic solvent was concentrated in vacuo, and the mixture was extracted with EA (3x). The combined organics w7ere washed with brine, dried over Na^SC^, filtered and concentrated in vacuo gave amino alcohol AAjl (130 mg) as a colorless oil. which was used without further purification.
[0278] 1 -(2,8-difluoro- 10, 1 1 -dihydro-5H-dibenzo[a,d] [7]annulen-5-yl)-2- (methylamino)ethanol was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 17, steps 4- 7, using 2.8-difluoro- 10, l l -dihydro-5H-dibenzo[a,d] [7]annulen-5-one (prepared following steps one and two of Example 14 using 3-fluorobenzoyl chloride and 4-fluoro-2- methylbenzoic acid).
EXAMPLE 18
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol (AAkl )
Figure imgf000102_0001
K-4 AAk1
[0279] Aryl bromide K-l (2 g, 8.73 mmol) and phenylboronic acid (1 .6 g, 13.1 mmol) were taken up in toluene (120 mL). To this mixture was added a solution of 2M sodium carbonate (50 mL). The flask was evacuated and back filled with Ar (3 cycles). Tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium (1 .01 g, 0.873 mmol) was added. The flask was evacuated and back filled with argon (3 cycles). The flask was placed in an oil bath heated to 80 °C and stirred overnight. The flask was cooled to ambient. The mixture was diluted with EA and washed successively with water and a brine solution. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography (25 g silica column, elution gradient 2% to 5% EA:hexanes) to provide K-2 as a light yellow oil (1.82 g).
[0280] Methyl ester K-2 (1.82 g, 8.05 mmol) was taken up in dry tetrahydrofuran (20 mL) and cooled in an ice bath under an Ar balloon. To this mixture was added a 1 M solution of lithium aluminum hydride in THF (9.7 ml, 9.66 mmol) via a slow dropwise addition over 5 mins. The mixture was stirred for 1 h at 0 °C. Water (0.16 mL) was added, and the mixture stirred for 10 mins. A solution of 5% NaOH (0.31 mL) was added, and the mixture stirred for 10 mins. Water (0.31 mL) was added, and the mixture stirred for 10 mins. The mixture was dried via addition of powdered magnesium sulfate. The mixture was filtered through a plug of eclite, rinsing with CH2CT2. The filtrate was transferred to a separator}' funnel and shaken with water. The organic phase was collected, dried with magnesium sulfate and filtered. The solvent removed to provide the intermediate alcohol ( 1 .519 g, semi-viscous white cloudy oil) which was used directly in the next step. An oven dried flask containing oxalyl chloride (0.55 mL, 9.80 mmol) in dry CLLC ( 12 mL) was cooled to -78 °C under Ar. To this mixture was added dimethylsulfoxide ( 1 .13 mL, 15.83 mmol), via slow dropwise addition. The mixture was stirred for 30 mins at -78 °C. A solution of intermediate alcohol (1 .494 g. 7.54 mmol) in dry CLLCL (3 mL) was added via slow dropwise addition. The mixture was stirred for 30 mins and then triethylamine (4.21 mL. 30.2 mmol) was added via dropwise addition. The flask was removed from the cooling bath, and stirred for 1.5 h. The mixture was taken up in CH2C12 and transferred to a separator}- funnel. A solution of saturated sodium bicarbonate was added and the mixture was shaken. The organic phase was collected and washed with a 50% diluted brine solution. The organic phase was collected, dried with magnesium sulfate, filtered and stripped. The crude remainder was purified by flash chromatography (25 g silica gel column, elution gradient 2% to 8% EA:hexanes) to provide K-3 as a pale yellow oil ( 179 mg).
[0281 ] A oven dried flask was charged with N,N-dimethyl-tert-butoxycarbamate (64 mg, 0.44 mmol; see Snieckus, V., et. al., Tet. Lett. (1994) 35(24):4067-4070) and tetramethy lethy lenediamine (0.1 mL, 0.66 mmol) and taken up in dry THF ( 1 .8 mL) under an Ar balloon. The mixture was cooled to -78 "C (acetone:dry ice bath). A solution of s-BuLi (0.39 mL. 0.46 mmol, 1 .2M in cyclohexane) was added via dropwise addition over approx.. 2 mins. The mixture was stirred at -78 °C for 75 mins. A solution of K-3 (173 mg, 0.88 mmol) in dry THF ( 1 .5 mL) was added via slow, dropwise addition over 10 mins. The mixture was stirred for 2 h at -78 °C and then stirred in an ice bath for 15 mins. To the mixture was added a solution of sat. aq. ammonium chloride (10 mL), water (15 mL) and EA (25 mL). The biphasic solution was shaken in a separator}' funnel, and the organic phase was collected. The aqueous phase was back extracted with EtOAc (2 x 20 mL). The combined organic phase was dried with magnesium sulfate, filtered. The solvent was removed, and the crude remainder was purified by preparative thin layer chromatography (2 plates) eluting with 25% EtOAc:hexane. The product band was collected, providing K-4 as a viscous yellow oil (86 mg). LCMS (ESI) m/∑= 342 [M+H]+. [0282] Compound K-4 (86 mg, 0.252 mmol) was taken up in dry dioxane (0.3 mL). The flask was cooled in an ice bath, and a solution of 4M hydrogen chloride in dioxane
(0.63 mL) was added. The mixture was stirred for 5 mins. and the cooling bath was removed.
The mixture was stirred at RT for 2 h. The mixture was concentrated, and the crude product was taken up in DCM (10 mL). The solvent was removed, and the remainder taken up in
DCM (10 mL). The solvent was removed (2x) to give amino alcohol AAkl as a gummy solid that was used directly in the next step without further purification.
EXAMPLE 19
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol (AAml)
Figure imgf000104_0001
AAm1
[0283] To a cooled (ice bath) solution of N-methyl-O-methylhydroxylamine hydrochloride (6.131 g, 62.85 mmol) and triethylamine (20 mL, 142.85 mmol) in dry DCM (under Ar atmosphere) was added 3-chlorobenzoyl chloride (7.32 mL, 57.14 mmol) via slo dropwise addition. The mixture was stirred for 10 mins and then warmed to ambient temperature. After 2.5 h of stirring, the solvent was partially removed (condense about 80% - rotary evaporator). The remainder was taken up in LA. washed successively with I N HC1 (twice) and 2M aqueous sodium carbonate, and then diluted a brine solution. The aqueous phases were back-extracted. The organic phases were combined, dried with magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to give L-l ( 10.6 g), which was used directly in the next step without further purification.
[0284] Compound L-l (2.04 g, 10.21 mmol) was taken up in dry THF (35 mL), and the flask was cooled to 0°C (ice bath) under Ar. Lo this mixture was added a THF solution of 1 .0 M 4-chlorophenylmagnesium bromide (20.42 mL. 20.42 mmol) via slow dropwise addition over 5 mins. The flask was warmed to ambient temperature, and the mixture was stirred for 3.5 h. The reaction was quenched with a solution of 5% aq. ammonium chloride (30 mL). water (30 mL) and EA (40 mL). The biphasic material was shaken, and the organic phase was collected. The mixture was washed with a diluted brine solution (60 mL), and the organic phase was collected. Lhe aqueous phases were back- extracted with EA (2 x 40 mL). Lhe organic phases were combined, dried with magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to give L-2 (3.084 g) which was used directly in the next step without further purification.
[0285] Lo a suspension of potassium tert-butoxide (2.24 g, 20 mmol) in dry LHF was added (methoxymethyl)triphenylphosphonium chloride (6.86 g, 20 mmol). Lhe mixture was stirred at ambient temperature under Ar for 30 mins. Lo this mixture was added a solution of L-2 (3.08 g, 10 mmol) in LHF (1 5 mL). Lhe flask was heated at 70 °C for 2.5 h. The mixture was cooled to ambient temperature and about 2/3 of the solvent was removed with a rotary evaporator. The remainder was taken up in EA and washed successively with water (2x) and then a brine solution. The crude remainder was purified by flash chromatography (25 g silica column, elution gradient 1 % to 2% EA:hexanes to provide L-3 as a clear oil (2.50 g, cis/trans mixture).
[0286] Compound L-3 (2.49 g, 8.92 mmol) was taken up in dioxane (75 mL). The solution was placed under mild vacuum and back-filled with Ar (4 cycles). To this mixture was added a solution of 70% HCIO4 (19 mL, 223 mmol), and the flask was heated at 70 "C via an oil bath for 90 mins. Lhe mixture was cooled to ambient temperature and partitioned between water (300 mL) and EtOAc (150 mL). Lhe organic phase was collected and washed consecutively with 50% diluted brine (2 x 200 mL). Lhe organic phase was collected, and the aqueous phases were back extracted with EtOAc (2 x 100 mL). Lhe EA phases were combined, dried with magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated. Lhe crude product was purified by flash chromatography (25 g silica gel column, elution gradient 1 % to 6% EA:hexanes) to provide L-4 as a pale yellow oil (1 .04 g).
[0287] Compound L-4 was converted to AAml (320 mg) following Example 1 8, steps 3 and 4.
[0288] 1 -(4-chlorophenyl)-3-(methylamino)-l -phenylpropan-2-ol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 19 and using (4- chlorophenyl)(phenyl)methanone.
[0289] 1 -(4-fluorophenyl)-3-(methylamino)-l -phenylpropan-2-ol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 19 and using (4- fluorophenyl )(phenyl )methanone .
[0290] 1 -(3-chlorophenyl)- 1 -(4-fluorophenyl)-3-(methylamino)propan-2-ol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 19 and using 4- fluorophenylmagnesium bromide.
[0291] 1 -(3-chlorophenyl)- l -(2-fluorophenyl)-3-(niethylarnino)propan-2-ol hydrochloride was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 19 and using 2- lithio fluorobenzene (prepared via Iithiation of 2-bromofluorobenzene using n-BuLi at -78 °C).
EXAMPLE 20
Synthesis of Amino Alcohol (AAfl)
Figure imgf000107_0001
AAf1
[0292] A suspension of 2-cyano-3-methylpyridine (1 .9 g, 16.06 mmol) in tert- butyl alcohol (5 mL) was heated at 70 °C. Concentrated sulfuric acid (1 .9 mL) was added over 10 mins. The reaction was complete after 4 h at 75 °C. The mixture was diluted with water and toluene, and brought to pH=10 with concentrated aqueous ammonia. The temperature was kept at 50-55 °C during workup. The toluene phase was separated, and the aqueous layer was extracted with water. Removal of the toluene yielded F-1 (3.3gr) as a crystalline solid.
[0293] To a cold (-40 °C) solution of F-1 (3.3 g, 17.16 mmol) in dry THF (64 mL) was added n-butyllithium in hexanes 1.6M (2 eq., 22 mL) while the temperature was maintained at -40 °C. The solution turned deep red after 1 eq. was added. Sodium bromide (0.1 eq., 176mg) was added, and the mixture was stirred 10 mins. A solution of benzyl chloride (leq., 2 mL) in dry THF (12 mL) was added while the temperature was lowered to - 40 °C. Lhe mixture was stirred for 30 mins. Water was added until the color dissipated. The mixture was extracted with EA, washed with water, dried on Na2S04 and concentrated in vacuo to give F-2 (4.7gr) as an oil. [0294] Compound F-2 (4.7 g, 16.67 mmol) was dissolved in toluene (40 mL) and POCI3 was added (10 eq., 15 mL). The mixture was refluxed for 5 h and then stirred at RT overnight. The mixture was poured into ice water ( 150 mL) and stirred for 0.5 h. The mixture was alkalized to pH=8 with 20% NaOH. The toluene phase was separated, and the aqueous layer was extracted with EA (3x). The organic layers were concentrated in vacuo to give F-3 (3.76 g, 18.08 mmol) as a brown oil.
[0295] Compound F-3. (2.5 g. 12 mmol) was added to polyphosphoric acid (50 g). The mixture was heated at 1 80 °C for 4 h. The mixture was poured into ice (50 g)- water ( 100 g). The mixture was made basic with 20% NaOH and extracted with EtOAc. The solvent was concentrated, and the crude product was purified by crystallization from hexane. F-4, (2gr 9.56mmol) as brown solid. Ή NMR (400 MHz, CDCI3) ppm 3.20-3.26 (m, 2 H) 3.27-3.32 (m, 2 H) 7.27 (d, J=7.53 Hz, 1 H) 7.38 (dd, J=7.28, 5.27 Hz, 2 H) 7.46-7.54 (m, 1 H) 7.65 (d, J=7.78 Hz, 1 H) 8.09 (d, J=8.03 Hz, 1 H) 8.66 - 8.76 (m, 1 H).
[0296] To a mixture of F-4 ( lg, 1 eq., 4.78 mmol) and acetic anhydride in THF (6.8 mL) at -25 °C were sequentially added Zn dust (3.4 eq., 1.06 g, 16.27 mmol) and triiluoroacetic acid (2.2 eq., 1.19g, 10.52 mmol) dropwise. The temperature of the mixture was slowly raised to RT and was stirred overnight. Additional Zn dust (3.4 eq.) and TFA (2.2eq.) were added. The mixture was stirred at 70 °C for 40 mins. Toluene was added. The zinc and inorganic residue were filtered and washed with toluene. The filtrate was washed with water and 1 M NaOH. The organic phase was concentrated under vacuum, and the residue was purified by silica-gel chromatography (100% Cychex to 50/50 Cychex/EtOAc in 12CV) to give F-5 (820 mg). Ή NMR (400 MHz, CDC13) d ppm 3.12-3.29 (m, 4 H) 4.42 (s. 2 H) 7.09 (dd, J=7.65. 4.89 Hz, 1 H) 7.14 - 7.22 (m, 2 H) 7.25-7.35 (m. 1 H) 7.40 (d. J=7.28 Hz, 1 H) 8.34 (dd, J=4.77, 1 .51 Hz. 1 H).
[0297] Following Example 6, route 2, F-5 was converted to amino alcohol AAfl . EXAMPLE 21
Synthesis of Compound 121
Figure imgf000109_0001
AAg1 121
[0298] Trimethylsulfoxonium iodide ( 1 .03 g, 4.68 mmol) was added to a mixture of Nai l (95%; 1 12 mg, 4.6 mmol) in DMSO (8 mL) at RT. The mixture was stirred for 30 min, and then a solution of G-2 (0.75 g. 3.12 mmol) in DMSO (2 mL) was added. The solution was heated at 60 °C for 1 .5 h and then diluted with water (75 mL) and hexane (50 mL). The aqueous layer was washed with hexane (2 x 30 mL), and the combined organic extract was washed with brine, dried over Na2S04. and concentrated to give G-4 as a yellow oil (680 mg), that was used directly in the next step.
[0299] Crude G-4 was dissolved in reagent alcohol (5 mL) and transferred to a glass sealed tube reactor. Isopropyl amine (1 .4 mL. 15.6 mmol) was added, and the mixture was heated at 60 °C for 12 h. Additional isopropyl amine ( 1 mL) was added, and the mixture was heated at 80 °C for 6 h and then concentrated. Ethyl acetate (5 mL) and 4M HCI in dioxane (xs) were added. Tiltration gave AAgl (228 mg, 21 %) as a white solid.
[0300] Following a similar procedure as in Example 7, substituting trifluoroacetic anhydride for methanesulfonyl chloride and triethylamine in step 2 and substituting TFA at 75 °C for 10% Pd/C for step 3, AAgl was converted to 121 (35 mg, 13%).
[0301] 8-(l,9-difiuoro- 10, 1 1 -dihydro-5H-dibenzo[a,d] [7]annulen-5-yl)-4- hydroxy-6-isopropyl-7,8-dihydro-3H-pyrazino[l ,2-b]pyridazine-3,5(6H) was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 21 , step 4 and using 1 -( 1 ,9-difluoro- 10, 1 - dihydro-5H-dibenzo[a,d][7Jannulcn-5-yl)-2-(isopropylamino)ethanol hydrochloride.
[0302] 4-hydroxy-6-methyl-8-(pheny l(pyridin-2-y l)methyl)-7,8-dihydro-3H- pyrazino[ 1.2-b]pyridazine-3,5(6H)-dione, was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 21 , step 4 and using 3-(methylamino)-l -phenyl-l -(pyridin-2-yl)propan-2-ol dihydrochloride.
[0303] l -((4-hydroxy-6-isopropyl-3,5-dioxo-5.6,7,8-tetrahydro-3H-pyrazino[1.2- b]pyridazin-8-yl)(phenyl)methyl)-l H-pyrazole-3-carbonitrile was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example 21 , step 4 and using l -(2-hydroxy-3-(isopropylamino)-l- phenylpropyl)- 1 H-pyrazole-3 -carbonitrile hydrochloride.
EXAMPLE 22
Synthesis of Compound 129
Figure imgf000110_0001
Figure imgf000111_0001
129-3 129-4
[0304] To a reactor Hushed with Ar was loaded potassium t-butoxide ( 13.71 g, 1.30 cq.), trimcthylsulfoxonium iodide (26.88 g, 1 .30 cq.). and anhydrous DMSO ( 100 mL). The mixture was stirred for 0.5 h. tv-deuterated benzophenone ( 1 8 g) was added, and the mixture was heated to 50-60 HC for 45 mins. After cooling to RT, hexane ( 100 mL) was added. A solution of acetic acid (2.62 g) in water (100 mL) was used to wash the mixture. The aqueous phase was extracted with hexanes (100 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with aq. sat. sodium bicarbonate, dried with sodium sulfate and concentrated. After cooling, the colorless oil ( 17.25 g) solidified, which was used in the next step without further purification.
[0305| To a reactor flushed with Ar was added indium(lll) chloride (2.16 g, 0.2 eq.). 129-1 ( 17.25 g) in anhydrous tetrahydrofuran ( 100 mL) was added. The mixture as stirred at 55 °C for 45 mins, cooled to RT and concentrated. The obtained concentrate was dissolved in hexane (100 mL), washed with water and brine, dried with sodium sulfate and concentrated to give 129-2 as a yellow oil (17.47 g), which was used in the next step without further purification.
[0306] To a reactor flushed with Ar was loaded trimethylsulfoxonium iodide (26.09 g, 1 .40 eq.). potassium t-butoxide (13.30 g. 1 .40 eq.). and anhydrous DMSO ( 100 mL). The mixture was stirred for 0.5 h. 129-2 (1 7.47 g) was added, and the mixture was rinsed with DMSO (25 mL): The mixture was heated to 50-60 °C for 45 mins, and then cooled to RT. The mixture was then diluted with hexane (100 mL). A solution of acetic acid (2.6 g) in water ( 100 mL) was used to wash the mixture. The organic phase was washed with water, dried with sodium sulfate and concentrated to obtain 129-3 as a yellow oil (15.0 g), which was used in the next step without further purification.
[0307] 129-3 (14.3 g), isopropylamine (22 mL, δ 0.688; -3.9 eq.). and reagent alcohol (22 mL) were combined. The mixture was heated in a 65 -°C oil bath for 10 mins. and then sealed and stirred overnight. The mixture was concentrated, and then dissolved in EA (150 mL). Hydrogen chloride (4 M) in dioxane (20 mL) was added and the precipitated white hydrochloride salt that formed was filtered. washed with EA and dried at 70 °C to give 129-4 (9.12 g).
[0308] Compound 129 was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example
21 (step 4) and using 129-4. m/z = 400.2 [M+H]+.
EXAMPLE 23
Synthesis of Compound 130
Figure imgf000112_0001
[0309] Compound 130 was prepared following a similar procedure as in Example
1 1 and using Compound 129. m/z = 470.3 [M+I I] +.
EXAMPLE 24
Additional Compounds
[0310] The foregoing syntheses are exemplary and can be used as a starting point to prepare a large number of additional compounds, such as those in Table 1A. Examples of compounds of Tormula (1) that can be prepared in various ways, including those synthetic schemes shown and described herein, are provided below. Those skilled in the art will be able to recognize modifications of the disclosed syntheses and to devise routes based on the disclosures herein; all such modifications and alternate routes are within the scope of the claims.
[0311 ] The following compounds in Table 1 A were prepared following one or methods described herein.
Table 1 A
Figure imgf000113_0001
Figure imgf000114_0001
-112-
Figure imgf000115_0001
Figure imgf000116_0001
-114-
Figure imgf000117_0001
Figure imgf000118_0001
-116-
Figure imgf000119_0001
Figure imgf000120_0001
-118-
Figure imgf000121_0001
Figure imgf000122_0001
-120-
Figure imgf000123_0001
Figure imgf000124_0001
-122-
Figure imgf000125_0001
Figure imgf000126_0001
Figure imgf000127_0001
Figure imgf000128_0001
Figure imgf000129_0001
Figure imgf000130_0001
Figure imgf000131_0001
Figure imgf000132_0001
Figure imgf000133_0001
Figure imgf000134_0001
Figure imgf000135_0001
- 1 JJ>-
Figure imgf000136_0001
Figure imgf000137_0001
Figure imgf000138_0001
-136-
Figure imgf000139_0001
-137-
Figure imgf000140_0001
-138-
Figure imgf000141_0001
-139-
Figure imgf000142_0001
-140-
Figure imgf000143_0001
Figure imgf000144_0001
-142-
Figure imgf000145_0001
-143-
Figure imgf000146_0001
-144-
Figure imgf000147_0001
-145-
Figure imgf000148_0001
Figure imgf000149_0001
-147-
Figure imgf000150_0001
-148-
Figure imgf000151_0001
-149-
Figure imgf000152_0001
-150-
Figure imgf000153_0001
Mass
M+H: 376
M+H: 456
M+H: 418
M+H: 418
Figure imgf000155_0001
Figure imgf000156_0001
-154-
Figure imgf000157_0001
Figure imgf000158_0001
-156-
Figure imgf000159_0001
-157-
Figure imgf000160_0001
-158-
Figure imgf000161_0001
-159-
Figure imgf000162_0001
-160-
Figure imgf000163_0001
-161-
Figure imgf000164_0001
-162-
Figure imgf000165_0001
-163-
Figure imgf000166_0001
Figure imgf000167_0001
Figure imgf000168_0001
-166-
Figure imgf000169_0001
EXAMPLE 25
Influenza Antiviral Assay
[0312] Human lung carcinoma A549 cells (ATCC, Manassas, VA) were plated at a density of 5 x 104 cells/mL (5 x 10J cells/well) in assay media (Ham"s F12 media supplemented with 0.3% FBS, 1 % penicillin/streptomycin (all Mediatech. Manassas, VA) and 1 % DMSO (Sigma-Aldrich. St Louis. MO)) in black 96-well plates. Alternatively. Madin-Darby canine kidney epithelial cells (MDCK. ATCC), were plated at a density of 1 x l O^ cells/mL (1 x 104 cells/well) in assay media (DMRM supplemented with 0.3% FBS, 1 % penicillin/streptomycin and 1% DMSO) in 96-well plates. After 24 hours, serially diluted test compounds were added to cells and incubated for an additional 24 hours. Cells were infected with 250 lU/well of Influenza strain A549_A/WSN/33 (H1N 1) (Virapur, San Diego CA) and incubated for 20 hours at 37°C, 5% C02. The cell culture supernatant was aspirated off and 50 μL of 25 μΜ 2"-(4-Methylumbelliferyi)-a-D-N-acetyineuraminic acid (Sigma- Aldrich) dissolved in 33 mM MES, pH 6.5 (Emerald Biosystems, Bainbridge Island, WA) was added to the cells. After incubation for 45 min at 30°C, reactions were stopped by addition of 150 stop solution ( 100 mM glycine, pH 10.5, 25% ethanol, all Sigma- Aldrich). Fluorescence was measured with excitation and emission filters of 355 and 460 nm, respectively, on a Victor X3 multi-label plate reader (Perkin Elmer, Waltham, MA). Cytotoxicity of uninfected parallel cultures was determined by addition of 100 μί^ of CellTitcr-Glo®reagcnt (Promega, Madison, WI), and incubation for 10 min at RT. Luminescence was measured on a Victor X3 multi-label plate reader.
[0313] Compounds of Formula (I) are active in the assay as noted in Table 2. where 'A' indicates an EQo < 20 μΜ, Έ" indicates an EC 0 of >20 μΜ and < 100 μΜ and indicates an EC50 > 100 μΜ.
Table 2
Figure imgf000170_0001
Figure imgf000170_0002
Figure imgf000170_0003
o. % Inhibition No. % Inhibition No. % Inhibition-B A 39-A A 70-A A0 A 39-B A 71 B2 A 40 A 71-A A
-A A 41 A 71 -B A-B A 41 -A A 72-A A3 A 42 A 73-A A-A A 42-A A 73-B A-B A 42-B B 74-A A4 A 45 A 75 -A A- A A 45-A A 76-A A6 A 45-B B 78 A7 A 46-A A 79-A A-B A 46-B B 80-A A8 A 47 A 81 -A A-A A 48 A 81 -B B-B A 49 A 82-A A9 A 50 A 83 A0 A 51 A 83-A A 1 A 51-A A 83-B B
-A A 52 A 84-A A -B A 52-A A 85-Λ B2 A 52-B A 86-A A3 A 53-A A 87-A A4 A 54 B 88-A A5 A 55 B 89 A6 A 56 A 89-A A7 A 57 A 89-B A8 A 58-A A 90 A9 A 59-A A 91-A B0 B 60 A 92-A A 1 A 61 A 93-A A2 A 62 A 94-A B-A A 63 A 95-A A-B A 63 -A A 96-A A4 A 63-B A 97-A A-A A 64 A 98-A A-B A 65 -A A 99 B6 A 66-A A 100 A-B A 67-A A 101 B-A A 68-A A 102 B8 A 68-B A 103 B9 A 69-A A 104 A No. % Inhibition No. % Inhibition No. % Inhibition
105 B 113-A A 124 A
105-A A 113-B B 125 A
105-B A 114 A 126 A
105-C A 114-A A 127 A
105-D B 114-B A 127-A A
106- A A 115 A 127-B A
107-A B 115-A A 127-C A
107-B B 115-B A 127-D A
108-A B 115-C A 128 A
108-B B 115-D A 129 A
109 A 116 A 130 A
109- A A 117 A 131 A
109-B A 118 A 132 A
109-C A 119 A 1 jj A
109-D A 120 A 134 A
110- A A 121 A 135 A
111 C 122 A 138 A
112 A 123 A
EXAMPLE 26
EN PA FRET Inhibition Assav
[0314| EN PA FRET inhibition assay was performed using a 19 nucleotide synthetic oligoribonucleotide substrate: 5'-FAM-AUUUUGUUUUUAAUAUUUC-BHQ-3' (Integrated DNA Technologies, Inc., Coralville, LA) (SEQ. ID. NO.1). Upon RNA cleavage, the fluorescent FAM group is released from the BHQ quencher. The PA sequence used to produce active enzyme is derived from any one of multiple influenza A virus strains (e.g., A/goosc/Nanchang/3- 120/01 (H3N2), A/Victoria/3/1975 (H3N2). A/Brisbane/ 10/2007 (H3N2). A/WSN/33 (H1N1), A/CA/4/2009 (H1N1), A/CA/5/2009 (H1N1). A/Shanghai/1/2013 (H7N9), A/Guizhou/1/2009 (H5N1)). The full length recombinant protein was expressed from a baculovirus vector in insect cells. Full length EN PA was used in this assay at an effective concentration of 1 to 10 Nm, together with 50 Nm FRET probe with a final volume of 20 ml cleavage buffer (20 Mm Tris Ph8, 100 Mm NaCl, 5% Glycerol. 10 Mm β-ΜΕ, 0.01% Tween-20, 2 Mm MnCl2).
[0315] Compounds described herein were added to a 384-well black polypropylene plate. Fluorescence was measured in a continuous mode up to 30 minutes with a Wallac 1420 Victor3 V multilabel counter (PerkinElmer Life Sciences, Shelton, CT) (excitation 485 nm; emission 535 nm). Measured IC50 is defined as the concentration at which fluorescence is 50% that of the uninhibited control (DMSO). IC50 was calculated by fitting the data to the sigmoidal equation Y= % Min + (% Max - % Min) / ( 1 + X / 1C50). where Y corresponds to the percent relative enzyme activity. Max is the maximum enzyme activity in the presence of DMSO, Min is the inhibited activity at saturating concentration of compound, and X corresponds to the compound concentration. The IC50 values were derived from the mean of a minimum of two independent experiments.
[0316] Compounds of Formula (I) are potent in the assay as noted in Table 3, where Ά" indicates an lCso 250 Nm, "Β' indicates an lC50 of >250 Nm and < 1000 Nm and 'C indicates an 1C50> 1000 Nm.
Table 3
Figure imgf000173_0001
Figure imgf000173_0002
Figure imgf000173_0003
Figure imgf000173_0004
Figure imgf000174_0001
EXAMPLE 27
Influenza B Assay
[0317] Viruses: The influenza virus strains B/Malaysia/2506/2004 and B/Victoria/504/2000 were purchased from Virapur (San Diego. CA). The viruses had been previously titrated on MDCK cells at Virapur using the TCID 0 method.
[0318| Human Cell Lines: Human lung carcinoma A549 cells were purchased from the ATCC (Manassas, VA. cat# CCL- 185) and cultured in Ham's F12 media supplemented with 10% FBS. 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% HEPES, 1% non-essential amino acids and 1% Glutamine (all Mediatech. Manassas, VA). A549 cells were maintained at 37 °C in a humidified 5% C02 atmosphere. [0319] Fluorescence-Based Influenza Neuraminidase Assay: Determination of the EC50 and CC50 in the fluorescence-based Influenza neuraminidase assay was performed by the following procedure. 24 hours prior to infection, A549 cells in assay media (Ham's F12 media supplemented with 0.3% FBS, 1 % penicillin/streptomycin, 1% HEPES. 1 % nonessential amino acids and 1 % Glutamine) were plated at a density of l x 10? cells/ml ( 1 x 104 cells/well) in white 96-well plates. On the day of infection, serially diluted compounds were added to cells. Cells were infected with 500 IU/well of influenza strains B/Malaysia/2506/2004 or B/Victoria/504/2000 and incubated for 20 h at 37°C, 5% C02. The cell culture supernatant was aspirated off and 50 μΐ of 25 μΜ 2'-(4-Methylumbelliferyl)-a-D- N-acetylneuraminic acid (Sigma-Aldrich) dissolved in 33 mM MRS, pH 6.5 (Emerald Biosystems. Bainbridge Island. WA) was added to the cells. After incubation for 45 minutes at 37°C. reactions were stopped by the addition of 150 μΐ stop solution (100 mM glycine, pH 10.5, 25% ethanol, all Sigma-Aldrich). Fluorescence was measured with excitation and emission filters of 355 and 460 nm, respectively, on a Victor X3 multi-label plate reader (Perkin Elmer. Waltham, MA).
[0320] Cell Viability Assay: Promega's CellTiter-Glo Luminescent Cell Viability Assay (Cat. #G7572) was used to measure cell viability. Assay plates were set up as described above and CellTiter-Glo reagent ( 100 μΐ^) was added to each well and incubated at room temperature for 10 minutes. Luminescence was recorded using a Perkin Elmer multilabel counter Victor3V. The CC50, the concentration of the drug required to reduce the number of viable cells by 50% in relation to the untreated cell control value, was calculated from the plot of percentage reductions of the luminescence value against the drug concentrations using the Microsoft Excel forecast function. All compound tested had CC50 values > 1 μΜ.
[0321 ] Compounds of Formula (I) are active in the assay as noted in Table 4. where 'A' indicates an EC50 < 20 μΜ, Έ" indicates an EC50 of >20 μΜ and < 100 μΜ and 'C indicates an EC50 > 100 μΜ. Table 4
Figure imgf000176_0003
Figure imgf000176_0001
Figure imgf000176_0002
EXAMPLE 28
Combination Studies
[0322] 24 hours prior to infection, dog kidney epithelial MDCK cells (ATCC. Manassas, VA) were plated in maintenance media (DMEM media supplemented w ith 10% FBS, 1 % penicillin/streptomycin. 1 % non-essential amino acids. 1 % Glutamine and 1 % HEPES (all Mediatech. Manassas. VA) at a density of 15 x 104 cells/ml (15 x 103 cells/well) in white 96-well plates with clear bottoms. At the day of infection, maintenance media was removed from cells. Compounds were serially diluted in assay media (MEM media without phenol-red, supplemented with 0.3% FBS. 1% penicillin/streptomycin, 1% non-essential amino acids, 1% Glutamine and 1% HEPES (all Mediatech, Manassas, VA) and 4 μ¾/ηι1 TPCK-treated trypsin (Affymetrix, Santa Clara, CA)) and added to cells. To determine drug- drug interactions (synergy), one compound was diluted horizontally and the second compound vertically to create a checker-board matrix of compound combinations at variable concentrations. Cells were infected at a MOI of 0.001 to 0.05 with Influenza strain A/Port Chalmers/1 /73 (H3N2) (Virapur, San Diego CA) and incubated for three days at 37°C. 5% C02. 100 of the cell culture supernatant was aspirated off and 100 μΐ CellTiter- Glo®reagent (Promega, Madison, WI) was added to the cells. After incubation for 10 mins at R.T.. Luminescence was measured on a Victor X3 multi-label plate reader (Perkin Elmer. Waltham. MA). Cytotoxicity of uninfected parallel cultures was determined at the same time. Drug interactions were calculated using the MacSynergy I M II tool developed by M.N. Prichard and C. Shipman Jr. (Prichard, M. N. et al.. Antiviral Res. (1990) 14(4-5): 181 -205).
[0323] The volumes of synergy (positive volumes) or antagonism (negative volumes) represent the relative quantity of synergism or antagonism per change in the concentrations of the two drugs. Synergy and antagonism volumes are defined based on the Bliss independence model. In this model, synergy volumes of less than -25 indicate antagonistic interactions, volumes in the -25 - 25 range indicate additive behavior, volumes in the 25 - 100 range indicate synergistic behavior and volumes > 100 indicate strong synergistic behavior. Determination of in vitro additive, synergistic and strongly synergistic behavior for combinations of compounds can be of utility in predicting therapeutic benefits for administering the combinations of compounds in vivo to infected patients.
[0324] The synergy volume results for the combinations are provided in Table 5.
Table 5
Figure imgf000177_0001
Figure imgf000178_0001
[03251 Furthermore, although the foregoing has been described in some detail by way of illustrations and examples for purposes of clarity and understanding, it will be understood by those of skill in the art that numerous and various modifications can be made without departing from the spirit of the present disclosure. Therefore, it should be clearly understood that the forms disclosed herein are illustrative only and are not intended to limit the scope of the present disclosure, but rather to also cover all modification and alternatives coming with the true scope and spirit of the invention.

Claims

WHAT IS CLAIMED IS:
1 . A compound of Formula (I), or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt wherein the compound of Fo
Figure imgf000179_0001
wherein:
is a single bond or double bond;
R1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, an unsubstituted C alkyl, -C(=0)Y' , -C(=0)-0-Y', -(CH2)-0-(C=0)-Y' , -(CH2)-0-(C=0)-0-Y' , - (CHCH3)-0-(C=0)-Y' and -(CHCH3)-0-(C=0)-0-Y' ;
R~ is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, an optionally substituted Ci-6 alkyl, an optionally substituted heterocyclyl, an optionally substituted cycloalkyl(C [ -6 alkyl), an optionally substituted aryl(C i-6 alkyl), an optionally substituted heteroaryl(C i -6 alkyl) and an optionally substituted heterocyclyl(C i -6 alkyl);
Ria and R,b are independently hydrogen or an optionally substituted C|-4 alkyl;
R4 and R? are independently selected lrom the group consisting of hydrogen, an optionally substituted aryl, an optionally substituted aryl(Ci -6 alkyl) an optionally substituted heteroaryl and an optionally substituted heteroaryl(C|-6 alkyl), provided that at least one of R4 and R? is not hydrogen; or
R4 and R5 are taken together to form an optionally substituted tricyclic cycloalkeny l or an optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl;
R6 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen. -CN. an optionally substituted C , alkyl, an optionally substituted aryl, an optionally substituted heteroaryl, -CFFOH. -CH(Y2)(OH) and -C(0)Y2; Y and Y" are independently selected from the group consisting of an optionally substituted d -6 alkyl, an optionally substituted C3-6 cycloalkyl, an optionally substituted aryl. an optionally substituted heteroaryl, an optionally substituted heterocyclyl, a mono-substituted amino group, a di -substituted amino and -C(R7)NHR8; and
7 8
R' and R° are independently hydrogen or an optionally substituted C alkyl.
2. The compound of Claim 1 , wherein R4 is hydrogen.
3. The compound of Claim 1 . wherein R4 is an optionally substituted aryl.
4. The compound of Claim 3, wherein the optionally substituted aryl is an optionally substituted phenyl.
5. The compound of Claim 1 , wherein R4 is an optionally substituted aryl(C | .6 alkyl).
6. The compound of Claim 1. wherein R4 is an optionally substituted heteroaryl.
7. The compound of Claim 6, wherein the optionally substituted heteroaryl is an optionally substituted imidazole or an optionally substituted pyrazole.
8. The compound of Claim 1 , wherein R4 is an optionally substituted hctcroaryl(C i -6 alkyl).
9. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -8, w herein R? is an optionally substituted aryl.
10. The compound of Claim 9, w herein the optionally substituted aryl is an optionally substituted phenyl.
1 1. The compound of any one of Claims 1-8, wherein R^ is an optionally substituted aryl(C i_6 alkyl).
12. The compound of any one of Claims 1-8, wherein R is an optionally substituted heteroaryl.
13. The compound of any one of Claims 1-8, wherein R^ is an optionally substituted heteroaryl(C i -6 alkyl).
14. The compound of Claim 1 , wherein R4 and R5 are each a substituted phenyl substituted with one or more group selected from fluoro. chloro, iodo, C M alkyl, C2-4 alkynyl, hydroxy, C M alkoxy, an optionally substituted phenyl, cyano, NC-(CH2)-, H2N-C(=0)- and optionally substituted
Figure imgf000181_0001
15. The compound of Claim 1 , wherein R4 and R? are taken together to form an optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl.
16. The compound of Claim 15. wherein the optionally substituted tricyclic heterocyclyl is an optionally substituted moiety selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000181_0002
The compound of Claim 15 or 16. wherein the tricyclic heterocyclyl substituted with one or more group selected from fiuoro. chloro, iodo and C alkyl.
18. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -17. wherein R2 is hydrogen.
19. The compound of any one of Claims 1 - 17, wherein R2 is an optionally substituted C | -6 alkyl.
20. The compound of Claim 19, wherein the optionally substituted Ci-6 alkyl is substituted with substituent selected from the group consisting of halogen, haloalky l, hydroxy and alkoxy.
21 . The compound of any one of Claims 1 -17. wherein R2 is an optionally substituted aryl(Ci-6 alkyl).
22. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -21 , wherein R1 is hydrogen.
23. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -21 , wherein R1 is an unsubstituted Ci_4 alkyl.
24. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -21 , wherein R is -C(=0)Y . -C(=0)- O-Y1 , -(CH2)-0-(C=0)-Y ', -(C y-CKC^C -O-Y 1, -(CHCH3)-0-(C=0)-Y' or -(CHCH3)-0-(C=0)-0-Y1.
25. The compound of Claim 24, R is -C(=0)Y' .
26. The compound of Claim 24, R1 is -C(=0)-0-Y' .
27. The compound of Claim 24. R1 is -(CH2)-0-(C=0)-Y' .
28. The compound of Claim 24, R1 is -(CH2)-0-(C=0)-0-Y' .
29. The compound of Claim 24, R1 is -(CHCH -O-(C=O)-Y' .
30. The compound of Claim 24, R1 is -(CHCH3)-0-(C=0)-0-Y' .
31. The compound of any one of Claims 24-30, Y1 is an optionally substituted C [.
6 alkvl.
The compound of any one of Claims 24-30, Y is an optionally substituted C3- cycloalkyl
The compound of any one of Claims 24-30. Y is an optionally substituted aryl.
34. The compound of any one of Claims 24-30, Y1 is an optionally substituted hcteroaryl.
35. The compound of any one of Claims 24-30. Y1 is an optionally substituted heterocyclyl.
36. The compound of any one of Claims 24-30. Y1 is a mono-substituted amino group.
37. The compound of any one of Claims 24-30, Y1 is a di-substituted amino
38. The compound of any one of Claims 24-30, Y1 is -C(R7)NHR8.
39. The compound of Claim 38, wherein R7 is hydrogen.
40. The compound of Claim 38, wherein R7 is an optionally substituted C | _4 alkyl.
41. The compound of any one of Claims 38-40, w herein R8 is hydrogen.
42. The compound of any one of Claims 38-40. wherein R8 is an optionally substituted C i .4 alkyl. -C(R7)NHR8 is selected from
Figure imgf000183_0001
, wherein Het can be an optionally substituted heteroaryl or an optionally substituted heterocvclvl.
44. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -43, wherein R6 is hydrogen.
45. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -43, wherein R6 is halogen or -CN.
46. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -43, wherein R6 is an optionally substituted C i -6 alkyl, an optionally substituted aryl or an optionally substituted heteroaryl.
47. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -43, wherein R6 is -CH2OH, - CH(Y2)(OH) or -C(0)Y2.
48. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -47, wherein Rja is hydrogen.
49. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -47, wherein Rja is an optionally substituted C alkyl.
50. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -49, wherein Rjb is hydrogen.
51 . The compound of any one of Claims 1 -49. wherein Rjb is an optionally substituted C M alkyl.
52. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -51 , wherein ------- is a single bond.
53. The compound of any one of Claims 1 -51 , wherein ------- is a double bond.
54. The compound of Claim 1 , wherein the compound is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000184_0001
Figure imgf000185_0001
-183-
Figure imgf000186_0001
-184-
Figure imgf000187_0001
Figure imgf000188_0001
Figure imgf000189_0001
187-
Figure imgf000190_0001
-188
Figure imgf000191_0001
-189-
Figure imgf000192_0001
acceptable salt of the foregoing.
Figure imgf000193_0001
-191-
Figure imgf000194_0001
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing.
56. The compound of Claim 1, wherein the compound is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure imgf000194_0002
Figure imgf000195_0001
Figure imgf000196_0001
Figure imgf000196_0002
pharmaceutically acceptable salt of the foregoing.
58. A pharmaceutical composition comprising an effective amount of a compound of any one of Claims 1 -57, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, diluent, excipient. or combination thereof.
59. A method for ameliorating or treating an orthomyxovirus infection comprising administering an effective amount of a compound of any one of Claims 1-57, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of Claim 58.
60. A method for inhibiting replication of an orthomyxovirus virus comprising contacting a cell infected with the virus with an effective amount of a compound of any one of Claims 1 -57. or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of Claim 58.
61 . A method for contacting a cell infected with an orthomyxovirus virus comprising contacting a cell infected with the virus with an effective amount of a compound of any one of Claims 1 -57. or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of Claim 58.
62. A method for ameliorating or treating an orthomyxovirus infection in combination with one or more agents comprising administering or contacting a cell with an effective amount of a compound of any one of Claims 1-57, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of Claim 58.
63. A method for inhibiting endonuclease activity of an influenza endonuclease comprising contacting the active site of the endonuclease with an effective amount of a compound of any one of Claims 1 -57, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of Claim 58.
64. The method of any one of Claims 59-61 , wherein the orthomyxovirus viral infection is influenza.
65. The method of Claim 62, wherein the orthomyxovirus viral infection is an influenza virus infection; and wherein the one or more agents is selected from the group consisting of a neuraminidase inhibitor, a M2 protein inhibitor, a polymerase inhibitor, a PB2 inhibitor, amantadine, rimantadine, zanamivir, oseltamivir, peramivir, laninamivir. laninamivir octanoate, favipiravir, fludase, ADS-8902. an immuno-modulator, beraprost, Neugene®, ribavirin, CAS Reg. No. 1422050-75-6, CAS Reg. No. 1259366-34-1 (VX-787), FluMist Quadrivalent® (Medlmmune), Fluarix® Quadrivalent (GlaxoSmithKline), Fluzone® Quadrivalent (Sanofi Pasteur), Flucelvax® (Novartis) and FluBlok® (Protein Sciences).
66. The method of 65, wherein the one or more agents is oseltamivir.
67. The method of any one of Claims 64-66, wherein the influenza is influenza A.
68. The method of any one of Claims 64-66, wherein the influenza is influenza B.
69. The method of any one of Claims 64-66, wherein the influenza is influenza C.
70. The method of any one of Claims 64-66, wherein the influenza is selected from the group consisting of H 1N 1 , H3N2, H5N 1 and H7N9.
71 . The method of any one of Claims 59-70, wherein the compound of any one of Claims 1 -57. or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or the pharmaceutical composition of Claim 58 is effective against more than 1 subtype of influenza.
72. Use of an effective amount of a compound of any one of Claims 1 -57. or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of Claim 58 in the preparation of a medicament for ameliorating or treating an orthomyxovirus viral infection.
73. Use of an effective amount of a compound of any one of Claims 1 -57, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of Claim 8 in the preparation of a medicament for inhibiting replication of an orthomyxovirus virus.
74. Use of an effective amount of a compound of any one of Claims 1 -57, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of Claim 8 in the preparation of a medicament for contacting a cell infected with an orthomyxovirus virus.
75. Use of an effective amount of a compound of any one of Claims 1 -57, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of Claim 58 in the preparation of a medicament for ameliorating or treating an orthomy xovirus viral infection in combination with one or more agents comprising administering or contacting a cell with an effective amount of the compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or the pharmaceutical composition.
76. Use of an effective amount of a compound of any one of Claims 1 -57. or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or a pharmaceutical composition of Claim 58 in the preparation of a medicament for inhibiting endonuclease activity of an influenza endonuclease.
77. The use of any one of Claims 72-74, wherein the orthomyxovirus viral infection is influenza.
78. The use of Claim 75, wherein the orthomyxovirus viral infection is an influenza virus infection; and wherein the one or more agents is selected from the group consisting of a neuraminidase inhibitor, a M2 protein inhibitor, a polymerase inhibitor, a PB2 inhibitor, amantadine, rimantadine, zanamivir. oseltamivir, peramivir, laninamivir, laninamivir octanoatc, favipiravir, fludase. ADS-8902, an immuno-modulator, beraprost, Neugene®. ribavirin. CAS Reg. No. 1422050-75-6. CAS Reg. No. 1259366-34- 1 (VX-787). FluMist Quadrivalent® (Medlmmune). Fluarix® Quadrivalent (GlaxoSmithKline). Fluzone® Quadrivalent (Sanofi Pasteur), Flucelvax® (Novartis) and FluBlok® (Protein
Sciences).
79. The use of 78, wherein the one or more agents is oseltamivir.
80. The use of any one of Claims 77-79. wherein the influenza is influenza A.
81. The use of any one of Claims 77-79. wherein the influenza is influenza B.
82. The use of any one of Claims 77-79, wherein the influenza is influenza C.
83. The use of any one of Claims 77-79, wherein the influenza is selected from the group consisting of H1N 1 , H3N2, H5N 1 and H7N9.
84. The use of any one of Claims 72-83, wherein the compound of any one of Claims 1 -57, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, or the pharmaceutical composition of Claim 58 is effective against more than 1 subtype of influenza.
PCT/US2014/055012 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof WO2015038655A1 (en)

Priority Applications (18)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
EP14844961.4A EP3030566B1 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 7,8-dihydro-3h-pyrazino[1,2-b]pyridazine-3,5(6h)-dione compounds and uses thereof
AU2014318832A AU2014318832B2 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
ES14844961T ES2821394T3 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 7,8-dihydro-3H-pyrazino [1,2-b] pyridazin-3,5 (6H) -dione compounds and uses thereof
CN201480061771.XA CN105764904B (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
KR1020217035836A KR102468319B1 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
NZ717591A NZ717591B2 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
UAA201602294A UA121199C2 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
JP2016542073A JP6448647B2 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
KR1020167009194A KR102323515B1 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
CA2923075A CA2923075C (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
EA201690372A EA037949B1 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
EP20184298.6A EP3778603A1 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 7,8-dihydro-3h-pyrazino[1,2-b]pyridazine-3,5(6h)-dione compounds and uses thereof
BR112016005270-6A BR112016005270B1 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 AZA-PYRIDONE COMPOUNDS, PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS AND THEIR USES
MX2016003199A MX2016003199A (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof.
IL244432A IL244432B (en) 2013-09-12 2016-03-03 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
PH12016500486A PH12016500486A1 (en) 2013-09-12 2016-03-11 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
AU2019201403A AU2019201403B2 (en) 2013-09-12 2019-02-28 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
IL274355A IL274355B (en) 2013-09-12 2020-04-30 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof

Applications Claiming Priority (6)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US201361877151P 2013-09-12 2013-09-12
US61/877,151 2013-09-12
US201462011784P 2014-06-13 2014-06-13
US62/011,784 2014-06-13
US201462031673P 2014-07-31 2014-07-31
US62/031,673 2014-07-31

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2015038655A1 true WO2015038655A1 (en) 2015-03-19

Family

ID=52626171

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2014/055012 WO2015038655A1 (en) 2013-09-12 2014-09-10 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof

Country Status (19)

Country Link
US (5) US9328119B2 (en)
EP (2) EP3030566B1 (en)
JP (1) JP6448647B2 (en)
KR (2) KR102323515B1 (en)
CN (1) CN105764904B (en)
AU (2) AU2014318832B2 (en)
BR (1) BR112016005270B1 (en)
CA (1) CA2923075C (en)
CL (1) CL2016000539A1 (en)
EA (1) EA037949B1 (en)
ES (1) ES2821394T3 (en)
HK (1) HK1225715A1 (en)
IL (2) IL244432B (en)
MX (2) MX2016003199A (en)
PE (1) PE20160661A1 (en)
PH (1) PH12016500486A1 (en)
TW (1) TWI652269B (en)
UA (1) UA121199C2 (en)
WO (1) WO2015038655A1 (en)

Cited By (14)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2016145103A1 (en) * 2015-03-11 2016-09-15 Alios Biopharma, Inc. Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
KR20170131651A (en) 2015-04-28 2017-11-29 시오노기세야쿠 가부시키가이샤 Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivatives and prodrugs thereof
WO2017223231A1 (en) 2016-06-21 2017-12-28 Alios Biopharma, Inc. (s)-8-(benzhydryl )-6-isopropyl-3,5-dioxo- 5, 6,7,8,-tetrahydro-3h-pyrazino-[1,2-b]pyridazin-yl-isobutyrate antiviral agent for use in treating influenza
WO2018030463A1 (en) 2016-08-10 2018-02-15 塩野義製薬株式会社 Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivative and pharmaceutical composition containing prodrug thereof
WO2018042303A1 (en) * 2016-08-29 2018-03-08 Novartis Ag Fused tricyclic pyridazinone compounds useful to treat orthomyxovirus infections
JP2018515527A (en) * 2015-05-13 2018-06-14 バーテックス ファーマシューティカルズ インコーポレイテッドVertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors of influenza virus replication
US10251882B2 (en) 2013-09-12 2019-04-09 Alios Biopharma, Inc. Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
KR20190049916A (en) 2015-04-28 2019-05-09 시오노기세야쿠 가부시키가이샤 Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivative and prodrug thereof
JP2019512485A (en) * 2016-03-08 2019-05-16 ノバルティス アーゲー Tricyclic compounds useful for the treatment of orthomyxovirus infections
US10364226B2 (en) 2013-09-12 2019-07-30 Alios Biopharma, Inc. Pyridazinone compounds and uses thereof
WO2019166950A1 (en) * 2018-02-28 2019-09-06 Novartis Ag 10-(di(phenyl)methyl)-4-hydroxy-8,9,9a,10-tetrahydro-7h-pyrrolo[1 ',2':4,5]pyrazino[1,2-b]pyridazine-3,5-dione derivatives and related compounds as inhibitors of the orthomyxovirus replication for treating influenza
WO2020055858A1 (en) * 2018-09-10 2020-03-19 Cocrystal Pharma, Inc. Pyridopyrazine and pyridotriazine inhibitors of influenza virus replication
US11040048B2 (en) 2015-12-15 2021-06-22 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Medicament for treating influenza characterized by combining a Cap-dependent endonuclease inhibitor and an anti-influenza drug
US11485753B2 (en) 2012-12-21 2022-11-01 Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv Substituted nucleosides, nucleotides and analogs thereof

Families Citing this family (11)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
AP3631A (en) 2009-06-17 2016-03-08 Vertex Pharma Inhibitors of influenza viruses replication
UA118010C2 (en) 2011-08-01 2018-11-12 Вертекс Фармасьютікалз Інкорпорейтед INFLUENCES OF INFLUENZA VIRUS REPLICATION
EP3294717B1 (en) 2015-05-13 2020-07-29 Vertex Pharmaceuticals Inc. Methods of preparing inhibitors of influenza viruses replication
WO2017072341A1 (en) 2015-10-30 2017-05-04 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Pyrimidone derivatives and their use in the treatment, amelioration or prevention of a viral disease
WO2017156407A1 (en) * 2016-03-10 2017-09-14 Alios Biopharma, Inc. Method of preparing aza-pyridone compounds
WO2017197055A1 (en) 2016-05-10 2017-11-16 C4 Therapeutics, Inc. Heterocyclic degronimers for target protein degradation
WO2017197046A1 (en) 2016-05-10 2017-11-16 C4 Therapeutics, Inc. C3-carbon linked glutarimide degronimers for target protein degradation
EP3454862B1 (en) 2016-05-10 2024-09-11 C4 Therapeutics, Inc. Spirocyclic degronimers for target protein degradation
AU2019210414B2 (en) * 2018-01-17 2021-04-01 Jiangxi Caishi Pharmaceutical Technology Co., Ltd. Pyridone derivative, composition thereof and application thereof as anti-influenza drug
CN115777154A (en) 2020-12-14 2023-03-10 学校法人关西大学 Electrode for electrochemical device and nonaqueous electrolyte secondary battery
CN117126044B (en) * 2023-04-12 2024-01-26 延边大学 Microwave-assisted synthesis method of methyl ketone compound

Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO1995020583A1 (en) * 1994-01-27 1995-08-03 Biota Scientific Management Pty. Ltd. Derivatives of 2-deoxy-2,3-dehydro-n-acetylneuraminic acid (dana)

Family Cites Families (37)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
TW200510425A (en) * 2003-08-13 2005-03-16 Japan Tobacco Inc Nitrogen-containing fused ring compound and use thereof as HIV integrase inhibitor
CN100357284C (en) * 2003-09-11 2007-12-26 浙江海正药业股份有限公司 Compounds against influenza virus and their preparing process and application
US20070161639A1 (en) * 2004-03-09 2007-07-12 Philip Jones Hiv integrase inhibitors
WO2005099699A1 (en) 2004-04-07 2005-10-27 Sepracor Inc. Combination of (s)-amlodipine and a beta-blocker, and methods for reducing hypertension
EP2522670A1 (en) 2004-04-07 2012-11-14 Takeda Pharmaceutical Company Limited Heterocyclic CRF receptor antagonists
ZA200702380B (en) 2004-09-03 2008-09-25 Celgene Corp Substituted heterocyclic compounds and uses thereof
CN101340902B (en) * 2005-11-28 2011-01-26 奥加生物药业(香港)有限公司 Materials and methods for treating viral infections with a cysteamine compound
AR057623A1 (en) 2005-11-28 2007-12-05 Omega Bio Pharma H K Ltd MATERIALS AND METHODS FOR THE TREATMENT OF VIRAL INFECTIONS
FR2909090B1 (en) 2006-11-23 2009-01-09 Sanofi Aventis Sa SUBSTITUTED 2,5-DIHYDRO-3H-PYRAZOLO [4,3-C] PYRIDAZIN-3-ONE DERIVATIVES, THEIR PREPARATION AND THEIR THERAPEUTIC USE.
DK2114903T3 (en) 2006-12-22 2011-04-18 Avexa Ltd Bicyclic pyrimidinones and their applications
FR2921505B1 (en) 2007-09-25 2014-01-31 Alstom Transport Sa RADIO COMMUNICATION DEVICE
JP2009096991A (en) 2007-09-27 2009-05-07 Fujifilm Corp Curable composition, image forming material, and lithographic printing original plate
WO2009053799A1 (en) 2007-10-24 2009-04-30 Glenmark Pharmaceuticals, S.A. Novel cannabinoid receptor ligands, pharmaceutical compositions containing them, and process for their preparation
EP2240491B1 (en) 2008-01-09 2015-07-15 Amura Therapeutics Limited TETRAHYDROFURO(2,3-b)PYRROL-3-ONE DERIVATIVES AS INHIBITORS OF CYSTEINE PROTEINASES
NZ612380A (en) 2008-12-09 2015-01-30 Gilead Sciences Inc Modulators of toll-like receptors
EP2375899B1 (en) 2009-01-12 2015-02-25 Array Biopharma Inc. Piperidine-containing compounds and use thereof in the treatment of diabetes
ME02337B (en) 2009-02-05 2016-06-20 Takeda Pharmaceuticals Co Pyridazinone compounds
AU2010216263A1 (en) 2009-02-23 2011-07-14 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Pyrazolo [4,3-c] cinnolin-3-one M1 receptor positive allosteric modulators
TW201038572A (en) 2009-03-25 2010-11-01 Gruenenthal Gmbh Substituted spiro-amide compounds
JP5697163B2 (en) 2009-03-26 2015-04-08 塩野義製薬株式会社 Substituted 3-hydroxy-4-pyridone derivatives
TWI518084B (en) * 2009-03-26 2016-01-21 鹽野義製藥股份有限公司 Process for pyrone and pyridone derivatives
WO2010138419A2 (en) * 2009-05-23 2010-12-02 Obio Pharmaceutical (H.K.) Ltd. Materials and methods for treating viral infections
ES2671550T3 (en) 2009-06-15 2018-06-07 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Polycyclic substituted carbamoylpyridone derivative
US8383638B2 (en) 2009-12-21 2013-02-26 Merck Sharp & Dohme Aminobenzoquinazolinone M1 receptor positive allosteric modulators
NZ601847A (en) * 2010-02-26 2014-03-28 Japan Tobacco Inc 1,3,4,8-tetrahydro-2h-pyrido[1,2-a]pyrazine derivative and use of same as hiv integrase inhibitor
US8987272B2 (en) 2010-04-01 2015-03-24 Critical Outcome Technologies Inc. Compounds and method for treatment of HIV
WO2012009194A1 (en) 2010-07-12 2012-01-19 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Tyrosine kinase inhibitors
HUE039859T2 (en) 2010-09-24 2019-02-28 Shionogi & Co Substituted polycyclic carbamoyl pyridone derivative prodrug
WO2013049352A2 (en) 2011-09-30 2013-04-04 Kineta, Inc. Anti-viral compounds
EP2943495B1 (en) 2013-01-08 2016-12-28 Savira Pharmaceuticals GmbH Pyrimidone derivatives and their use in the treatment, amelioration or prevention of a viral disease
ES2724581T3 (en) 2013-09-12 2019-09-12 Janssen Biopharma Inc Pyridazinone compounds and uses thereof
AU2014318832B2 (en) 2013-09-12 2018-11-29 Janssen Biopharma, Inc. Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
CR20160557A (en) 2014-05-29 2017-01-20 Glaxosmithkline Ip Dev Ltd COMPOUNDS DERIVED FROM 1- (CICLOPENT-2-EN-1-IL) -3- (2-HIDROXI-3- (ARILSULFONIL) PHENYL) UREA AS CXCR2 INHIBITORS
MX2017011655A (en) * 2015-03-11 2018-04-30 Alios Biopharma Inc Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof.
WO2017156407A1 (en) 2016-03-10 2017-09-14 Alios Biopharma, Inc. Method of preparing aza-pyridone compounds
WO2017223231A1 (en) 2016-06-21 2017-12-28 Alios Biopharma, Inc. (s)-8-(benzhydryl )-6-isopropyl-3,5-dioxo- 5, 6,7,8,-tetrahydro-3h-pyrazino-[1,2-b]pyridazin-yl-isobutyrate antiviral agent for use in treating influenza
JOP20170169A1 (en) * 2016-08-29 2019-01-30 Novartis Ag Fused tricyclic pyridazinone compounds useful to treat orthomyxovirus infections

Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO1995020583A1 (en) * 1994-01-27 1995-08-03 Biota Scientific Management Pty. Ltd. Derivatives of 2-deoxy-2,3-dehydro-n-acetylneuraminic acid (dana)

Non-Patent Citations (16)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
ANDREW STREITWIESERCLAYTON HEATHCOCK: "Introduction to Organic Chemistry", 1981, pages: 169 - 171
BIOCHEM., vol. 11, 1972, pages 942 - 944
CHEMICAL ABSTRACTS, Columbus, Ohio, US; abstract no. 1259366-34-1
CHEMICAL ABSTRACTS, Columbus, Ohio, US; abstract no. 1422050-75-6
FRANCIS CAREY: "Organic Chemistry", 1992, pages: 328 - 331
GILCHRIST, T. L. ET AL.: "Formation of Pyridazino[6,1-c][1,4]oxazin-8(7H)-ones by Intramolecular Cycloaddition of Azoalkenes", JOURNAL OF THE CHEMICAL SOCIETY, PERKIN TRANSACTIONS 1, 1987, pages 2517 - 2522, XP055331680 *
GOPISHETTY, TETRAHEDRON: ASYMMETRY, vol. 22, no. 10, 2011, pages 1081 - 1086
HASSALL, C. H. ET AL.: "Amino-acids and Peptides. Part XII. The Molecular Structures of the Monamycins, Cyclodepsipeptide Antibiotics", JOURNAL OF THE CHEMICAL SOCIETY C: ORGANIC, 1971, pages 526 - 532, XP055331683 *
J.F.W. MCOMIE: "Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry", 1973, PLENUM PRESS
JOHN MCMURRY: "Organic Chemistry", 2000, pages: 398,408
MARTZ, K.E., J. MED. CHEM., vol. 55, no. 17, 2012, pages 7862 - 7874
PRICHARD, M. N. ET AL., ANTIVIRAL RES., vol. 14, no. 4-5, 1990, pages 181 - 205
See also references of EP3030566A4
SNIECKUS, TET. LETT., vol. 35, no. 24, 1994, pages 4067 - 4070
SNIECKUS, V., TET. LETT., vol. 35, no. 24, 1994, pages 4067 - 4070
T. W. GREENEP. G. M. WUTS: "Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis", 1999, JOHN WILEY & SONS

Cited By (44)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11485753B2 (en) 2012-12-21 2022-11-01 Janssen Pharmaceutica Nv Substituted nucleosides, nucleotides and analogs thereof
US10980805B2 (en) 2013-09-12 2021-04-20 Janssen Biopharma, Inc. Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
US10702523B2 (en) 2013-09-12 2020-07-07 Janssen Biopharma, Inc. AZA-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
US10364226B2 (en) 2013-09-12 2019-07-30 Alios Biopharma, Inc. Pyridazinone compounds and uses thereof
US10251882B2 (en) 2013-09-12 2019-04-09 Alios Biopharma, Inc. Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
US10208045B2 (en) 2015-03-11 2019-02-19 Alios Biopharma, Inc. Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
CN107531717B (en) * 2015-03-11 2021-07-27 詹森生物制药有限公司 Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
CN107531717A (en) * 2015-03-11 2018-01-02 艾丽奥斯生物制药有限公司 Azepine pyridinone compounds and application thereof
EA036776B1 (en) * 2015-03-11 2020-12-21 Янссен Байофарма, Инк. Azapyridone compounds and methods of use thereof
WO2016145103A1 (en) * 2015-03-11 2016-09-15 Alios Biopharma, Inc. Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
US10633397B2 (en) 2015-04-28 2020-04-28 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivatives and prodrugs thereof
KR20170131651A (en) 2015-04-28 2017-11-29 시오노기세야쿠 가부시키가이샤 Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivatives and prodrugs thereof
EP3428170A1 (en) 2015-04-28 2019-01-16 Shionogi & Co., Ltd Anti-influenza polycyclic pyridone derivative and prodrug thereof
KR20190049916A (en) 2015-04-28 2019-05-09 시오노기세야쿠 가부시키가이샤 Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivative and prodrug thereof
US20180118760A1 (en) 2015-04-28 2018-05-03 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivatives and prodrugs thereof
KR20190002742A (en) 2015-04-28 2019-01-08 시오노기세야쿠 가부시키가이샤 Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivative and prodrug thereof
US10392406B2 (en) 2015-04-28 2019-08-27 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivatives and prodrugs thereof
EP4424314A2 (en) 2015-04-28 2024-09-04 Shionogi & Co., Ltd Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivative and prodrug thereof
EP4219508A1 (en) 2015-04-28 2023-08-02 Shionogi & Co., Ltd Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivative and prodrug thereof
JP2018515527A (en) * 2015-05-13 2018-06-14 バーテックス ファーマシューティカルズ インコーポレイテッドVertex Pharmaceuticals Incorporated Inhibitors of influenza virus replication
US11040048B2 (en) 2015-12-15 2021-06-22 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Medicament for treating influenza characterized by combining a Cap-dependent endonuclease inhibitor and an anti-influenza drug
JP2019512485A (en) * 2016-03-08 2019-05-16 ノバルティス アーゲー Tricyclic compounds useful for the treatment of orthomyxovirus infections
US11453677B2 (en) 2016-03-08 2022-09-27 Novartis Ag Tricyclic compounds useful to treat orthomyxovirus infections
WO2017223231A1 (en) 2016-06-21 2017-12-28 Alios Biopharma, Inc. (s)-8-(benzhydryl )-6-isopropyl-3,5-dioxo- 5, 6,7,8,-tetrahydro-3h-pyrazino-[1,2-b]pyridazin-yl-isobutyrate antiviral agent for use in treating influenza
KR20190007517A (en) 2016-08-10 2019-01-22 시오노기세야쿠 가부시키가이샤 A pharmaceutical composition containing a substituted polycyclic pyridone derivative and a prodrug thereof
US10759814B2 (en) 2016-08-10 2020-09-01 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Pharmaceutical compositions containing substituted polycyclic pyridone derivatives and prodrug thereof
US11306106B2 (en) 2016-08-10 2022-04-19 Shionogi & Co., Ltd. Pharmaceutical compositions containing substituted polycyclic pyridone derivatives and prodrug thereof
WO2018030463A1 (en) 2016-08-10 2018-02-15 塩野義製薬株式会社 Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivative and pharmaceutical composition containing prodrug thereof
KR20190018469A (en) 2016-08-10 2019-02-22 시오노기세야쿠 가부시키가이샤 Substituted polycyclic pyridone derivative and pharmaceutical composition containing prodrug thereof
JP2019532033A (en) * 2016-08-29 2019-11-07 ノバルティス アーゲー Fused tricyclic pyridazinone compounds useful for treating orthomyxovirus infection
US11912715B2 (en) 2016-08-29 2024-02-27 Novartis Ag Fused tricyclic pyridazinone compounds useful to treat orthomyxovirus infections
US11098051B2 (en) * 2016-08-29 2021-08-24 Novartis Ag Fused tricyclic pyridazinone compounds useful to treat orthomyxovirus infections
WO2018042303A1 (en) * 2016-08-29 2018-03-08 Novartis Ag Fused tricyclic pyridazinone compounds useful to treat orthomyxovirus infections
EP3848372A1 (en) * 2016-08-29 2021-07-14 Novartis AG Fused tricyclic pyridazinone compounds useful to treat orthomyxovirus infections
US20200123167A1 (en) * 2016-08-29 2020-04-23 Novartis Ag Fused tricyclic pyridazinone compounds useful to treat orthomyxovirus infections
JP7221861B2 (en) 2016-08-29 2023-02-14 ノバルティス アーゲー Fused Tricyclic Pyridazinone Compounds Useful for Treating Orthomyxovirus Infections
EP4356969A3 (en) * 2016-08-29 2024-05-22 Novartis AG Fused tricyclic pyridazinone compounds useful to treat orthomyxovirus infections
TWI803467B (en) * 2016-08-29 2023-06-01 瑞士商諾華公司 Fused tricyclic pyridazinone compounds useful to treat orthomyxovirus infections
CN111801333A (en) * 2018-02-28 2020-10-20 诺华股份有限公司 10- (di (phenyl) methyl) -4-hydroxy-8, 9,9a, 10-tetrahydro-7H-pyrrolo [1',2':4,5] pyrazino [1,2-b ] pyridazine-3, 5-dione derivatives and related compounds as inhibitors of orthomyxovirus replication for the treatment of influenza
US11629149B2 (en) 2018-02-28 2023-04-18 Novartis Ag 10-(di(phenyl)methyl)-4-hydroxy-8,9,9A,10-tetrahydro-7H-pyrrolo[1′,2′:4,5]pyrazino[1,2-b]pyridazine-3,5-dione derivatives and related compounds as inhibitors of the orthomyxovirus replication for treating influenza
US12071441B2 (en) 2018-02-28 2024-08-27 Novartis Ag 10-(di(phenyl)methyl)-4-hydroxy-8,9,9A,10-tetrahydro-7H-pyrrolo[1′,2′:4,5]pyrazino[1,2-b]pyridazine-3,5-dione derivatives and related compounds as inhibitors of the orthomyxovirus replication for treating influenza
WO2019166950A1 (en) * 2018-02-28 2019-09-06 Novartis Ag 10-(di(phenyl)methyl)-4-hydroxy-8,9,9a,10-tetrahydro-7h-pyrrolo[1 ',2':4,5]pyrazino[1,2-b]pyridazine-3,5-dione derivatives and related compounds as inhibitors of the orthomyxovirus replication for treating influenza
WO2020055858A1 (en) * 2018-09-10 2020-03-19 Cocrystal Pharma, Inc. Pyridopyrazine and pyridotriazine inhibitors of influenza virus replication
US12037333B2 (en) 2018-09-10 2024-07-16 Cocrystal Pharma, Inc. Pyridopyrazine and pyridotriazine inhibitors of influenza virus replication

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
AU2019201403A1 (en) 2019-03-21
EA037949B1 (en) 2021-06-10
IL244432B (en) 2020-05-31
MX2016003199A (en) 2016-06-02
US10702523B2 (en) 2020-07-07
US20210186969A1 (en) 2021-06-24
US20150072982A1 (en) 2015-03-12
BR112016005270A2 (en) 2017-12-12
US10251882B2 (en) 2019-04-09
KR102468319B1 (en) 2022-11-16
EP3030566B1 (en) 2020-07-08
CA2923075A1 (en) 2015-03-19
TWI652269B (en) 2019-03-01
EA201690372A1 (en) 2016-08-31
US20160228438A1 (en) 2016-08-11
EP3778603A1 (en) 2021-02-17
BR112016005270B1 (en) 2022-11-01
ES2821394T3 (en) 2021-04-26
IL244432A0 (en) 2016-04-21
AU2019201403B2 (en) 2021-01-21
KR20210135359A (en) 2021-11-12
TW201542553A (en) 2015-11-16
ES2821394T8 (en) 2021-05-12
PE20160661A1 (en) 2016-08-05
AU2014318832B2 (en) 2018-11-29
UA121199C2 (en) 2020-04-27
AU2014318832A1 (en) 2016-04-28
CN105764904A (en) 2016-07-13
CL2016000539A1 (en) 2016-09-02
US20190314373A1 (en) 2019-10-17
KR20160052715A (en) 2016-05-12
MX2020012132A (en) 2021-01-29
PH12016500486A1 (en) 2016-05-16
KR102323515B1 (en) 2021-11-05
US9328119B2 (en) 2016-05-03
CN105764904B (en) 2020-02-11
US20200030328A1 (en) 2020-01-30
US10980805B2 (en) 2021-04-20
EP3030566A1 (en) 2016-06-15
JP2016530314A (en) 2016-09-29
CA2923075C (en) 2022-07-26
EP3030566A4 (en) 2017-03-22
JP6448647B2 (en) 2019-01-09
IL274355A (en) 2020-06-30
NZ717591A (en) 2021-10-29
IL274355B (en) 2021-02-28
HK1225715A1 (en) 2017-09-15

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US10702523B2 (en) AZA-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
AU2016229147B2 (en) Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof
EP3030549B1 (en) Pyridazinone compounds and uses thereof
NZ717591B2 (en) Aza-pyridone compounds and uses thereof

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 14844961

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2923075

Country of ref document: CA

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 244432

Country of ref document: IL

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 201690372

Country of ref document: EA

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: MX/A/2016/003199

Country of ref document: MX

Ref document number: 2014844961

Country of ref document: EP

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2016542073

Country of ref document: JP

Kind code of ref document: A

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 000369-2016

Country of ref document: PE

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 16071186

Country of ref document: CO

REG Reference to national code

Ref country code: BR

Ref legal event code: B01A

Ref document number: 112016005270

Country of ref document: BR

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: A201602294

Country of ref document: UA

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 20167009194

Country of ref document: KR

Kind code of ref document: A

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 14114

Country of ref document: GE

Kind code of ref document: P

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: IDP00201602433

Country of ref document: ID

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 2014318832

Country of ref document: AU

Date of ref document: 20140910

Kind code of ref document: A

REG Reference to national code

Ref country code: BR

Ref legal event code: B01E

Ref document number: 112016005270

Country of ref document: BR

ENP Entry into the national phase

Ref document number: 112016005270

Country of ref document: BR

Kind code of ref document: A2

Effective date: 20160309